Fujitsu Universal Remote IRMC S2 S3 User Manual

User Guide - English  
ServerView Suite  
Remote Management  
iRMC S2/S3 - integrated Remote Management Controller  
Edition July 2012  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
Preface  
Modern server systems are becoming increasingly complex. The requirements  
with respect to the management of such systems are growing accordingly.  
In response to this development, a number of vendors founded the “Intelligent  
Platform Management Interface” (IPMI) initiative with the objective of defining a  
standardized, abstract, message-based interface between the central system  
controller (Baseboard Management Controller - BMC) and intelligent hardware  
for platform management. For further details on IPMI, please refer to section  
The integrated Remote Management Controllers iRMC S2 and iRMC S3 (in the  
following iRMC S2/S3 for short) each represent a BMC with integrated LAN  
connection and extended functionality. In this way, the iRMC S2/S3 offers  
comprehensive control over PRIMERGY servers, irrespective of the system  
status. In particular, the iRMC S2/S3 allows for out-of-band management  
(Lights Out Management, LOM) of PRIMERGY servers. Out-of-band  
management uses of a dedicated management channel that enables a system  
administrator to monitor and manage servers via remote control regardless of  
whether the server is powered on.  
Figure 1: iRMC S2 on the system board of a PRIMERGY server  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
 
Purpose and target groups of the manual  
As an autonomous system on the system board of a modern PRIMERGY  
server, the iRMC S2/S3 has its own operating system, its own web server,  
separate user management and independent alert management. The  
iRMC S2/S3 remains powered up even when the server is in stand-by mode.  
This manual describes how to configure the iRMC S2/S3 and the various user  
interfaces available.  
1.1  
Purpose and target groups of the manual  
This manual is aimed at system administrators, network administrators, and  
service staff who have a sound knowledge of hardware and software. It provides  
basic information on the technology behind IPMI and deals with the following  
aspects in detail:  
Logging on to the iRMC S2/S3  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3  
User management on the iRMC S2/S3  
Advanced Video Redirection via iRMC S2/S3  
Remote Storage via iRMC S2/S3  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Telnet/SSH-based interface (Remote Manager) of the iRMC S2/S3  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 with the Server Configuration Manager  
Updating the firmware  
Remote installation of the operating system via iRMC S2/S3  
IPMI OEM Commands  
Service  
If you have any further questions on remote management for PRIMERGY  
servers, contact the service and support partners responsible for you.  
Other information  
http://www.ts.fujitsu.com  
12  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Functions of the iRMC S2/S3  
1.2  
Functions of the iRMC S2/S3 (overview)  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports a wide range of functions that are provided by  
default. With Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) and Remote Storage, the  
iRMC S2/S3 also provides two additional advanced features for the remote  
management of PRIMERGY servers. To use AVR and Remote Storage, you  
require a valid license key, which can be purchased separately.  
Standard functions of the iRMC S2/S3  
Browser access  
The iRMC S2/S3 features its own web server which can be accessed by the  
management station from a standard web browser.  
Security (SSL, SSH)  
Secure access to the Web server and secure graphical console redirection  
including mouse and keyboard can be provided over HTTPS/SSL. An  
encrypted connection protected using SSH mechanisms can be set up to  
access the iRMC S2/S3 using the Remote Manager. The Remote Manager  
is an alphanumeric user interface for the iRMC S2/S3.  
ServerView Integration  
The ServerView agents detect the iRMC S2/S3 and automatically assign it  
to the relevant server. This means that it is possible to start the iRMC S2/S3  
web interface and text console redirection using the ServerView Remote  
Management Frontend directly from ServerView Operations Manager.  
Power management  
Irrespective of the status of the system, you have the following options for  
powering the managed server up or down from the remote workstation  
using the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
using the Remote Manager and the command line interface (CLP)  
with a script.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13  
 
Functions of the iRMC S2/S3  
Power consumption control  
The iRMC S2/S3 allows comprehensive power consumption control on the  
managed server. In addition, you can specify the mode (minimum power  
consumption or maximum performance) that the iRMC S2/S3 uses to control  
power consumption on the managed server. You can switch between these  
modes as required.  
Customer Self Service (CSS)  
Summary tables for the server components, sensors and the power supply  
on the iRMC S2/S3 web interface provide information in a separate column  
as to whether the server component affected is a CSS component or not. In  
addition, error list of the system event log (SEL) shows for every event  
whether it has been triggered by a CSS component.  
Text console redirection  
You can start a Telnet/SSH session to the iRMC S2/S3 from the ServerView  
Remote Management Frontend. This calls the Remote Manager, via which  
you can start a text console redirection session.  
Basic functions of a BMC  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports the basic functions of a BMC such as voltage  
monitoring, event logging and recovery control.  
“Headless” system operation  
The managed server does not require a mouse, monitor or keyboard to be  
connected. The benefits of this include lower costs, far simpler cabling in the  
rack and increased security.  
Identification LED  
To facilitate identification of the system, for instance if it is installed in a fully  
populated rack, you can activate the identification LED from the iRMC S2/S3  
web interface.  
Global error LED  
A global error LED informs you of the status of the managed system at all  
times and at the same time shows the CSS (Customer Self Service) status.  
Power LED  
The power LED informs you whether the server is currently switched on or  
off.  
14  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions of the iRMC S2/S3  
LAN  
On some systems, the LAN interface of the fitted system NIC (Network  
Interface Card) on the server is reserved for the management LAN. On other  
systems, you have the option of configuring this LAN interface to  
reserve it for the management LAN  
set it up for shared operation with the system or  
make it completely available to the system.  
The ports marked with a wrench symbol are assigned to the iRMC S2/S3  
Command line interface (CLP)  
In addition to the Remote Manager, the iRMC S2/S3 also supports SMASH  
CLP (System Management Architecture for Server Hardware Command  
Line Protocol) as standardized by the DMTF (Distributed Management Task  
Force).  
Simple configuration - interactive or script-based  
The following tools are available for configuring the iRMC S2/S3:  
iRMC web interface  
Server Configuration Manager  
The server management tool IPMIVIEW  
BIOS Setup  
It is also possible to carry out configuration with the Server Configuration  
Manager or IPMIVIEW using scripts. This means that it is possible to  
configure the iRMC S2/S3 when the server is first configured via ServerView  
Installation Manager. It is also possible to configure a large number of  
servers on the basis of scripts.  
Support for the LocalView service panel  
If PRIMERGY servers are equipped with a ServerView local service panel,  
this module allows you to determine what module is faulty and whether you  
can replace the faulty module yourself.  
Local user management  
The iRMC S2/S3 has its own user management function which allows up to  
16 users to be created with passwords and to be assigned various rights  
depending on the user groups they belong to.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15  
Functions of the iRMC S2/S3  
Global user management using a directory service  
The global user IDs for the iRMC S2/S3 are stored centrally in the directory  
service's directory. This makes it possible to manage the user identifications  
on a central server. They can therefore be used by all the iRMC S2/S3s that  
are connected to this server in the network.  
The following directory services are currently supported for iRMC S2/S3  
user management:  
Microsoft® Active Directory  
Novell® eDirectory  
OpenLDAP  
OpenDS  
CAS-based single sign-on (SSO) authentication  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports Centralized Authentication Service (CAS)  
configuration, which allows you to configure the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
for CAS-based single sign-on (SSO) authentication.  
The first time a user logs in to an application (e.g. the iRMC S2/S3 web  
interface) within the SSO domain of the CAS service, they are prompted for  
their credentials by the CAS-specific login screen. Once they have been  
successfully authenticated by the CAS service, the user is granted access  
to the iRMC S2/S3 web interface as well as to any other service within the  
SSO domain without being prompted for login credentials again.  
DNS / DHCP  
The iRMC S2/S3 provides support for automatic network configuration. It  
has a default name and DHCP support is set by default so that the  
iRMC S2/S3 gets its IP address from the DHCP server. The iRMC S2/S3  
name is registered by the Domain Name Service (DNS). Up to five DNS  
servers are supported. If DNS/DHCP is not available, the iRMC S2/S3 also  
supports static IP addresses.  
Power supply  
The iRMC S2/S3 is powered by the standby supply of the system.  
Alert management  
The alert management facility of the iRMC S2/S3 provides the following  
options for forwarding alerts (alerting):  
Platform Event Traps (PET) are sent via SNMP.  
Direct alerting by email.  
16  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions of the iRMC S2/S3  
A modem can be connected to the serial interface. This can then be used  
to send alerts (e.g. to a mobile phone via SMS).  
In addition, the iRMC S2/S3 provides the ServerView agents with all the  
relevant information.  
Read, filter and save the system event log (SEL).  
You can view, save and delete the contents of the SEL  
by using the iRMC S2/S3 web interface or  
by using the Telnet/SSH-based interface (Remote Manager) of the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
Read, filter and save the internal event log (iEL).  
You can view, save and delete the contents of the iEL  
by using the iRMC S2/S3 web interface or  
by using the Telnet/SSH-based interface (Remote Manager) of the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
Extended functionality of the iRMC S2/S3  
Alongside the standard functionality, the iRMC S2/S3 also supports the  
Advanced Video Redirection and Remote Storage functions.  
Advanced Video Redirection (AVR)  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports Advanced Video Redirection which offers the  
following benefits:  
Operation over a standard web browser. No additional software needs to  
be installed in the management station other than the Java Runtime  
Environment.  
System-independent graphical and text console redirection (including  
mouse and keyboard).  
Remote access for boot monitoring, BIOS administration and operation  
of the operating system.  
AVR supports up to two simultaneous “virtual connections” for working  
on a server from a different location. It also reduces the load on the  
network by using hardware and video compression.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
17  
Functions of the iRMC S2/S3  
Local monitor-off support: It is possible to power down the local screen  
of the managed PRIMERGY server during an AVR session in order to  
prevent unauthorized persons from observing user input and actions  
carried out on the local server screen during the AVR session.  
Low bandwidth  
In the case of a reduced data transfer rate, you can configure a lower  
bandwidth (bits per pixel, bpp) in terms of color depth for your current  
AVR session.  
Remote Storage  
Remote Storage makes a “virtual” drive available which is physically located  
on a remote workstation or made available centrally on the network using a  
Remote Storage server.  
The “virtual” drives available with Remote Storage are simply managed in  
much the same way as local drives and offer the following options:  
Read and write data.  
Boot from Remote Storage.  
Install drivers and small applications.  
Update BIOS from remote workstation.  
(BIOS update via USB)  
Remote Storage supports the following device types to provide a “virtual  
drive” on the remote workstation:  
CD ROM  
DVD ROM  
Memory stick  
Floppy image  
CD ISO image  
DVD ISO image  
A Remote Storage server provides an ISO image centrally on the network in  
the form of a “virtual drive”.  
Remote Storage permits either the simultaneous connection of up to two  
“virtual” drives at the remote workstation or the provision of an ISO image  
via a Remote Storage server.  
18  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communication interfaces of the iRMC S2/S3  
1.3  
Communication interfaces of the  
iRMC S2/S3  
The iRMC S2/S3 provides the following communication interfaces:  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface (web interface)  
The connection to the iRMC S2/S3 web server is established over a  
standard web browser (e.g. Microsoft Internet Explorer, Mozilla Firefox).  
Among other things, the web interface of the iRMC S2/S3 provides you with  
access to all system information and data from the sensors such as fan  
speeds, voltages, etc. You can also configure text-based console redirection  
and start graphical console redirection (Advanced Video Redirection, AVR).  
In addition, administrators can fully configure the iRMC S2/S3 over the web  
interface. Secure access to the iRMC S2/S3 web server can be provided  
with HTTPS/SSL.  
Operation of the iRMC S2/S3 over the web interface is described in chapter  
Remote Manager: Text-based Telnet/SSH interface via LAN  
You can call the Remote Manager  
from the ServerView Remote Management Frontend,  
directly from a Telnet/SSH client.  
The alphanumeric user interface of the Remote Manager provides you with  
access to system and sensor information, power management functions and  
the error event log. In addition, you can launch text console redirection or a  
SMASH CLP shell. If you call the Remote Manager over SSH (Secure Shell),  
the connection between the Remote Manager and the managed server is  
encrypted.  
Operation of the iRMC S2/S3 using the Remote Manager is described in  
Remote Manager (Serial): Text-based serial interface over Serial 1  
The Remote Manager (serial) interface is identical to the Remote Manager  
interface.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
19  
 
Communication protocols used by the iRMC S2/S3  
1.4  
Communication protocols used by the  
iRMC S2/S3  
The communication protocols and ports used by the iRMC S2/S3 are shown in  
Remote side of the  
connection  
Communication  
direction  
iRMC S2/S3 side of the connection  
(port number / protocol)  
RMCP  
623/UDP  
623/UDP  
80/TCP  
HTTP port  
HTTPs port  
Telnet  
80/TCP  
443/TCP  
443/TCP  
3172/TCP  
3172/TCP  
22/TCP  
SSH  
22/TCP  
Trap  
162/UDP  
25/TCP  
Email  
25/TCP  
Remote Storage  
5901/TCP  
5901/TCP  
VNC ports  
Standard port  
80/TCP  
80/TCP  
443/TCP  
443/TCP  
Secure port  
Table 1: Communication protocols and ports used by the iRMC S2/S3  
I
As of iRMC S2/S3 firmware version 5.00, the Remote Storage port is  
used only for the Remote Storage server and client-internal  
communications. For integrated Remote Storage (via the Java applet),  
the http port is used.  
20  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
IPMI - technical background  
1.5  
IPMI - technical background  
The iRMC S2/S3 makes the BMC functions available over the IPMI interface.  
Intelligent Platform Management  
The “Intelligent Platform Management” initiative is a response to the increasing  
complexity of modern server systems. A number of manufacturers have joined  
this initiative in order to come up with a new solution for monitoring these server  
systems.  
The term “Intelligent Platform Management” expresses the core aspect of this  
approach to the solution: Functions for monitoring and recovery of systems are  
implemented directly in the hardware and firmware for platform management.  
Objective  
The objective was to define a standardized, abstract and message-based  
interface between the central system controller (Baseboard Management  
Controller - BMC) and intelligent platform management hardware.  
The standardization committees combined the central characteristics of various  
platform management modules into standardized descriptions.  
Definition  
The IPMI specification defines:  
“IPMI is a hardware level interface specification that is ‘management  
software neutral’ providing monitoring and control functions that can be  
exposed through standard management software interfaces such as  
DMI, WMI, CIM, SNMP, etc. As a hardware level interface, it sits at the  
bottom of a typical management software stack” [see section "IPMI and  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21  
 
IPMI - technical background  
Advantage  
The IPMI specifications ensure the independence of functions for inventory,  
logging, recovery and monitoring of a system by the system processor, BIOS or  
operating system.  
This means that a system can still be involved in platform management when it  
is shut down and turned off.  
IPMI and other management standards  
IPMI is best used in conjunction with system management software running  
under the relevant operating system. Integration of the IPMI functionality into the  
management functionality offered by a management application and the  
operating system results in a powerful platform management environment.  
An overview of the relationship between IPMI and the management software  
stack is shown by figure 2:  
Figure 2: IPMI in the management software stack (source: IPMI specification, see section  
22  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
IPMI - technical background  
IPMI, IPMB and ICMB  
The IPMI initiative resulted in three central standards:  
IPMI. Intelligent Platform Management Interface Specification  
describes the higher-level architecture, the current commands, event  
formats, data packets and properties that are used in IPMI-based systems.  
IPMB. Intelligent Platform Management Bus  
is an I2C based (write only) bus, which provides a standardized connection  
between various modules in a common housing.  
IPMB can also be used as a standardized interface for remote management  
modules.  
ICMB. Intelligent Chassis Management Bus  
(Not currently implemented in the ServerView remote management  
environment.)  
provides a standardized interface for exchange of platform management  
information and for control across systems. ICMB is designed in such a way  
that it can be implemented with a device that is connected to the IPMB.  
IPMI implementation  
The core element of an IPMI implementation is the Baseboard Management  
Controller (BMC).  
The BMC performs the following tasks:  
The BMC organizes the interface between the system management  
software and the platform management hardware.  
It provides autonomous functions for monitoring, event logging and recovery  
control.  
The BMC acts as a gateway between the system management software and  
IPMB.  
IPMI allows platform management to be extended: Additional management  
controllers can be connected via the IPMB. The IPMB is an I2C based serial  
bus, which runs between the main modules of the system. It is used for  
communication with and between the management controllers.  
With the support of multiple management controllers, IPMI provides a scalable  
architecture: A complex server system can use multiple controllers for  
monitoring different subsystems, e.g. power supplies, hot swap RAID drive  
modules etc.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
23  
IPMI - technical background  
In addition, IPMI provides ‘low level’ I2C commands, which can be accessed via  
a management controller connected to the IPMB on 'unintelligent' I2C modules  
that cannot process IPMI commands.  
An overview of the fundamental elements of an IPMI implementation is available  
24  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI - technical background  
Figure 3: IPMI block diagram (source: IPMI specification, see section  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
25  
 
IPMI - technical background  
IPMI and “in band” and “out of band” management  
In the field of system management, a distinction is made between “in-band” and  
“out-of-band” management:  
The term “in-band” management is used when the operating system is  
running on the managed server.  
The term “out-of-band” management is used when the operating system is  
not running on the managed server, for instance if the hardware is faulty.  
As different interfaces are available in an environment with IPMI compatible  
systems, you can manage IPMI compatible systems either “in band” or “out of  
band”.  
IPMI-over-LAN  
“IPMI-over-LAN” is the current name for the specification of the LAN interface in  
the IPMI standard. This specification stipulates how IPMI messages can be sent  
to or from the BMC of a managed system - encapsulated in RMCP (Remote  
Management Control Protocol) data packets. These RMCP data packets are  
transferred via an Ethernet LAN connection using the UDP (User Datagram  
Protocol) under IPv4 (Internet Protocol Version 4).  
The RMCP protocol has been specified to support the management of system  
statuses in which the operating system is not running. The RMCP is a simple  
inquiry/response protocol.  
The interface for such a connection is provided on an onboard LAN controller  
assigned to the BMC.  
I
The interface can only be provided by an on-board LAN controller, not by  
an inserted LAN card.  
26  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI - technical background  
Of the two ports that RCMP uses under UDP, the BMC communicates with the  
LAN controller via port 623 (primary RMCP Port).  
Figure 4: BMC and LAN controller  
Serial Over LAN interface (SOL)  
“Serial Over LAN” is an interface compliant with the IPMI V2.0 standard, which  
controls transfer of serial data over a LAN connection. In particular, SOL  
specifies the packet formats and protocols for transferring serial data streams  
over a LAN between the serial controller on the managed computer and a  
remote workstation. SOL is based on the IPMI-over-LAN specification.  
In order to establish an SOL connection, a remote management application first  
initiates an IPMI-over-LAN session with the BMC. After this has been done, the  
SOL services can be activated from the remote workstation. The data traffic  
between the serial controller and the remote workstation is handled over the  
same IPMI session as the IPMI commands.  
As soon as an SOL connection has been established, data transfer between the  
serial controller and the remote workstation is carried out as follows:  
Transfer from the serial controller to the remote workstation:  
The data stream issued by the serial controller is partitioned by the BMC,  
packaged and then sent to the remote workstation over the LAN.  
Transfer from the remote workstation to the serial controller:  
BMC unpacks the characters contained in the packages sent by the remote  
workstation and forwards them to the serial controller as a character stream.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
27  
 
IPMI - technical background  
Figure 5: BMC and SOL  
The SOL character data is then exchanged between the BMC of the managed  
system and the remote workstation as SOL messages. The SOL messages are  
encapsulated in RMCP+ data packets and transferred in UDP datagrams over  
an Ethernet LAN connection using IPv4 (Internet Protocol Version 4). The  
RMCP+ protocol is based on the RMCP protocol, but includes extensions for  
encryption, authentication, etc.  
Serial over LAN permits “headless” management by console redirection by both  
the BIOS and the operating system of the managed server. High-cost  
concentrator solutions are not required.  
Channel concept under IPMI  
‘Channels’ provide the mechanisms with which IPMI messages are routed to  
the BMC via various connection carriers. Up to nine channels can be supported.  
The system interface and the primary IPMB are fixed. The other seven channels  
are available for the implementation.  
Channels can be either ‘session based’ or ‘sessionless’. The ‘session’ concept  
has two meanings: It is either a concept for user authentication (see the section  
"User identifications" on page 29) or a concept for routing multiple IPMI  
message streams via a single channel.  
Examples of ‘session based’ channels are LAN channels or serial / modem  
channels. Examples of ‘sessionless’ channels are the system interface and the  
IPMB.  
28  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Data Center Management Interface (DCMI)  
User identifications  
For ‘session based’ channels (see the section "Channel concept under IPMI" on  
page 28), a user login is necessary. By contrast, the ‘sessionless’ channels  
have no user authentication.  
Under IPMI, the user configuration is channel specific. Thus, users can have  
different privileges depending on whether they are accessing the BMC via the  
LAN channel or the serial channel.  
References  
Information about the IPMI standards can be found on the Internet:  
http://developer.intel.com/design/servers/ipmi/index.htm  
1.6  
DCMI (Data Center Management Interface)  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports the DCMI (Data Center Management Interface)  
protocol, which is compliant with the IPMI V2.0 standard. DCMI has been  
designed to improve manageability and energy efficiency of server systems that  
are deployed in large data centers.  
To meet the hardware management requirements of servers within data  
centers, DCMI supports, among others, the following key features:  
Inventory functions (server identification)  
Power Management and power monitoring  
Power consumption monitoring and control  
Event logging  
Temperature monitoring  
Detailed information about DCMI can be found on the DCMI home page:  
http://www.intel.com/technology/product/DCMI  
iRMC S2/S3  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Changes compared with the previous version  
1.7  
Changes since the previous versions of the  
manual  
iRMC S2/S3 - integrated Remote Management Controller  
(edition July 2012)  
This manual refers to the iRMC S2/S3 firmware version 6.5x and replaces the  
following online manual: “iRMC S2/S3 - integrated Remote Management  
Controller”, May 2012 edition.  
The manual includes the following updates:  
The "0 Watt Technology" feature is described in Chapter "7 iRMC S2/S3 web  
interface".  
The former chapter "12 IPMI OEM Commands" has been expanded and is  
now an Appendix ("12 Appendix") to the manual, containing the following  
sections:  
"12.1 IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3" (former  
chapter "12 IPMI OEM Commands")  
"12.2 Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration"  
(new section).  
iRMC S2/S3 - integrated Remote Management Controller  
(edition May 2012)  
This manual refers to the iRMC S2/S3 firmware version 6.5x and replaces the  
following online manual: “iRMC S2 - integrated Remote Management  
Controller”, November 2011 edition.  
New iRMC S2/S3 features (described in Chapter "7 iRMC S2/S3 web  
interface"):  
Agentless HDD monitoring (iRMC S3 only)  
If the managed server supports the "agentless HDD monitoring" feature, the  
HDD<n> status of each individual HDD is directly read and reported to the  
iRMC S2/S3 via a dedicated lightpath status sensor and thus can be  
displayed even in the case no ServerView agents are running.  
Backing up/restoring BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
If the BIOS of the managed server meets the corresponding feature  
requirements, the iRMC S2/S3 allows you to perform the following actions:  
30  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Changes compared with the previous version  
Backing up several BIOS parameters in ServerView® WinSCU XML  
format and restoring them in ServerView® WinSCU XML format from a  
file.  
Updating BIOS via "upload from file" or via TFTP.  
For some server types, you can select the Low Noise mode under  
Power Consumption Options (iRMC S3 only).  
iRMC S2/S3 - integrated Remote Management Controller  
(edition November 2011)  
This manual refers to the iRMC S2/S3 firmware version 5.5x and replaces the  
following online manual: “iRMC S2 - integrated Remote Management  
Controller”, May 2011 edition.  
The following topics are no longer part of this manual:  
Former section "4.4 Global user management for the iRMC S2/S3". As of  
SVOM V5.50, this section will be integrated in the "User Management in  
ServerView" manual.  
Description of the Server Configuration Manager dialog pages (former  
sections 9.2 and the following). Instead, the reader is advised to use the  
Online Help of the Server Configuration Manager.  
iRMC S2/S3 - integrated Remote Management Controller  
(edition May 2011)  
This manual refers to the iRMC S2/S3 firmware version 5.5x and replaces the  
following online manual: “iRMC S2 - integrated Remote Management  
Controller”, April 2011 edition.  
The manual applies to both iRMC S2 and iRMC S3. Functional differences in  
between the iRMC S2 and the iRMC S3 are pointed out separately in the  
manual.  
iRMC S2 - integrated Remote Management Controller (edition April 2011)  
The April 2011 edition of the iRMC S2 manual refers to the iRMC S2 firmware  
version 5.5x and replaces the following online manual: “iRMC S2 - integrated  
Remote Management Controller”, July 2010 edition.  
New iRMC S2 features:  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
31  
Changes compared with the previous version  
In addition to the system event log (IPMI SEL), the iRMC S2 now features  
an internal event log.  
The iRMC S2 now supports both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses.  
The iRMC S2 now supports the Open DS directory service.  
iRMC S2 Configuration (iRMC S2 firmware settings) can be restored via  
the iRMC S2 web interface.  
Email alerting is now also supported for global iRMCS2 user IDs.  
Chapter "5 Advanced Video Redirection (AVR)":  
In addition to some minor changes, the menu of the AVR window has been  
supplemented with the Power Control entry, allowing you now to power on /  
power down / reboot the server directly from the AVR window.  
Chapter "7 iRMC S2 web interface":  
Power Supply page: The Power Supply Redundancy Configuration feature is  
available for some server types.  
System Event Log Content page:  
GUI language "German":  
Event description and resolutions are described in German.  
GUI language "Japanese":  
Resolutions are described in Japanese.  
The DNS Configuration page now additionally includes the functionality of  
the former DHCP configuration page, which is no longer available.  
New / modified pages corresponding to the new iRMC S2 features  
mentioned above.  
Chapter "8 Remote Manager":  
New / modified menus corresponding to the new iRMC S2 features internal  
event log and IPv6 addressing.  
Chapter "9 Server Configuration Manager":  
New / modified menu pages corresponding to the new iRMC S2 features  
IPv6 addressing and Open DS support.  
32  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changes compared with the previous version  
1.8  
ServerView Suite link collection  
Via the link collection, Fujitsu Technology Solutions provides you with numerous  
downloads and further information on the ServerView Suite and PRIMERGY  
servers.  
For ServerView Suite, links are offered on the following topics:  
Forum  
Service Desk  
Manuals  
Product information  
Security information  
Software downloads  
Training  
I
The downloads include the following:  
Current software versions for the ServerView Suite as well as  
additional Readme files.  
Information files and update sets for system software components  
(BIOS, firmware, drivers, ServerView agents and ServerView update  
agents) for updating the PRIMERGY servers via ServerView Update  
Manager or for locally updating individual servers via ServerView  
Update Manager Express.  
The current versions of all documentation on the ServerView Suite.  
You can retrieve the downloads free of charge from the Fujitsu  
Technology Solutions Web server.  
For PRIMERGY servers, links are offered on the following topics:  
Service Desk  
Manuals  
Product information  
Spare parts catalogue  
Access to the link collection  
You can reach the link collection of the ServerView Suite in various ways:  
iRMC S2/S3  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Documentation for the ServerView Suite  
1. Via ServerView Operations Manager.  
Ê
Select Help – Links on the start page or on the menu bar.  
This opens the start page of the ServerView link collection.  
2. Via the ServerView Suite DVD 2 or via the start page of the online  
documentation for the ServerView Suite on the Fujitsu Technology Solutions  
manual server.  
I
You access the start page of the online documentation via the  
following link:  
Ê
Ê
In the selection list on the left, select Industry standard servers.  
Click the menu item PRIMERGY ServerView Links.  
This opens the start page of the ServerView link collection.  
3. Via the ServerView Suite DVD 1.  
Ê
Ê
Ê
In the start window of the ServerView Suite DVD 1, select the option  
Select ServerView Software Products.  
Click Start. This takes you to the page with the software products of the  
ServerView Suite.  
On the menu bar select Links.  
This opens the start page of the ServerView link collection.  
1.9  
Documentation for ServerView Suite  
The documentation for the ServerView Suite can be found on the ServerView  
Suite DVD 2 supplied with each server system.  
The documentation can also be downloaded free of charge from the Internet.  
You will find the online documentation at http://manuals.ts.fujitsu.com under the  
link Industry standard servers.  
34  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notational conventions  
1.10 Notational conventions  
The meanings of the symbols used in this manual are as follows:  
V
Warning  
This symbol is used to draw attention to risks which  
may represent a health hazard or which may lead  
to data loss or damage to the hardware.  
I
This symbol is used to highlight important  
information and tips.  
Ê
This symbol indicates an action which you must  
carry out.  
Text in italics  
In running text, commands, menu items, and the  
names of buttons, options, files and paths are  
shown in italics.  
<text>  
Indicates variables which must be replaced by  
current values.  
Monospaced font  
Output from the system is shown in monospaced  
font.  
Monospaced font  
Commands to be entered at the keyboard are  
Bold monospaced font shown in bold, monospaced font.  
[square brackets]  
{braces}  
Indicate optional entries.  
Indicate a list of alternatives separated by “|”.  
[Keyboard] [symbols]  
Keys are shown as they appear on the keyboard. If  
uppercase characters are to be entered explicitly,  
this is indicated for instance by [SHIFT] - [A] for A.  
If two keys are to be pressed simultaneously, this  
is indicated by a hyphen between the two keyboard  
symbols.  
Table 2: Notational conventions  
If reference is made to passages elsewhere in this manual, the title of the  
chapter or section is named and the page number given refers to the start of the  
section.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
35  
 
Notational conventions  
36  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
Logging on to the iRMC S2/S3 for  
the first time  
The factory default settings of the iRMC S2/S3 allow you to log in to the  
iRMC S2/S3 for the first time without the need for any configuration activities.  
2.1  
Requirements  
On the remote workstation:  
Windows: Internet Explorer as of Version 7.x:  
Linux: Mozilla Firefox 3.x.  
For console redirection:  
Sun Java Virtual Machine Version 1.5.0_06 or higher.  
In your network:  
You must have a DHCP server in your network.  
If you want to log in with a symbolic name rather than an IP address at the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface, the DHCP server in your network must be  
configured for dynamic DNS.  
DNS must be configured. Otherwise you must ask for the IP address.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
37  
   
iRMC S2/S3 factory defaults  
2.2  
iRMC S2/S3 factory defaults  
The firmware of the iRMC S2/S3 provides a default administrator ID and a  
default DHCP name for the iRMC S2/S3.  
Default administrator ID:  
Administrator ID:  
Password:  
admin  
admin  
I
Both the administrator ID and the password are case-sensitive.  
For reasons of security, it is recommended that you create a new  
administrator account once you have logged in, and then delete the  
default administrator account or at least change the password for the  
Default DHCP name of the iRMC S2/S3  
The default DHCP name of the iRMC S2/S3 uses the following pattern:  
IRMC<SerialNumber>  
I
The serial number corresponds to the last 3 bytes of the MAC address of  
the iRMC S2/S3. You can take the MAC address of the iRMC S2/S3 from  
the label on your PRIMERGY server.  
After you have logged in, the MAC address of the iRMC S2/S3 can be  
found as a read-only entry above the fields on the page Network Interface  
38  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Logging into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
2.3  
Logging into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Ê
Open a web browser on the remote workstation and enter the DNS name or  
IP address of the iRMC S2/S3.  
I
You can take the DNS name of the iRMC S2/S3 from the label on your  
PRIMERGY server.  
The following login prompt appears:  
Figure 6: Login prompt for the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
If the login prompt does not appear, check the LAN connection (see  
Ê
Ê
Type in the data for the default administrator account.  
User name: admin  
Password: admin  
Click OK to confirm your entries.  
The iRMC S2/S3 web interface opens showing the System Information page (see  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
39  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3  
The following tools are available for configuring the iRMC S2/S3:  
BIOS / TrustedCore / UEFI setup utility (see page 44)  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see page 135)  
Server Configuration Manager (see page 347)  
This chapter provides you with information about the following topics:  
Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2/S3 using the BIOS /  
TrustedCore / UEFI setup utility (see page 44).  
Configuring text console redirection via LAN using the BIOS / TrustedCore /  
UEFI setup utility (see page 48).  
Configuring the serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3 using the BIOS /  
TrustedCore / UEFI setup utility (see page 57).  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 over the web interface (for an overview, see  
page 63).  
3.1  
Configuring the LAN interface of the  
iRMC S2/S3  
This section describes:  
Requirements for configuring the LAN interface  
Configuring the LAN interface in the BIOS / TrustedCore® / UEFI setup utility  
Testing the LAN interface  
I
"Spanning Tree" tree for the connection of the iRMC S2/S3 must be  
deactivated (e.g. Port Fast=enabled; Fast Forwarding=enabled).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
41  
     
Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
3.1.1 Prerequisites  
Note the following requirements with respect to configuring the IP address:  
The LAN cable must be connected to the correct port. (see section  
Interaction between the IP addresses of the iRMC S2/S3 and the system  
3.1.1.1 Connected to the correct LAN port?  
The interface for a LAN connection is provided on an onboard LAN controller  
assigned to the iRMC S2/S3 (see also figure 4 on page 27).  
Depending on the server type, the system board of a PRIMERGY server  
provides two or three LAN interfaces. The ports marked with a wrench symbol  
are assigned to the iRMC S2/S3 (in figure 7, for example, these are port 1 and  
the top left-hand port).  
I
Check that the LAN cable is connected to the correct port.  
Depending on the type of PRIMERGY server, different ports may be  
marked with the wrench symbol.  
Dedicated Service / Management LAN  
(port exclusively for the  
Shared LAN  
(iRMC S2/S3 and system)  
(1)  
iRMC S2/S3; with the iRMC S3  
a LAN speed up to 1000 MBit/s  
is available, depending on the  
server hardware.)  
LAN (port exclusively  
for the system)  
(2)  
Figure 7: Ports for the iRMC S2/S3 (indicated by wrench symbol)  
42  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
3.1.1.2 Interaction between the IP addresses of the iRMC S2/S3 and the  
system  
The LAN controller of the PRIMERGY server requires a separate IP address for  
the iRMC S2/S3 in order to ensure that data packets are reliably transferred to  
the iRMC S2/S3 (and not to the operating system).  
The IP address of the iRMC S2/S3 must be different from that of the system  
(operating system).  
3.1.1.3 Access from a different subnet  
If the remote workstation accesses the iRMC S2/S3 of the managed server from  
a different subnet and DHCP is not used, you must configure the gateway.  
3.1.2 Configuring the LAN interface: Configuration tools  
You can configure the iRMC S2/S3’s LAN interface in a number of ways:  
Depending on the type of the PRIMERGY server  
using the BIOS / TrustedCore / UEFI setup utility (see page 44),  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see section "Network Settings - Configure the  
using the Server Configuration Manager (see chapter "Configuring  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
43  
     
Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
3.1.3 Configuring the LAN interface using the BIOS /  
TrustedCore / UEFI setup utility  
You can configure the iRMC S2/S3’s LAN interface using the BIOS /  
TrustedCore / UEFI setup utility:  
Use the BIOS / TrustedCore setup utility to configure the LAN interface of the  
iRMC S2.  
Use the UEFI (Unified Extensible Firmware Interface) setup utility to  
configure the LAN interface of the iRMC S3.  
3.1.3.1 Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2 by using the BIOS  
/ TrustedCore setup utility  
I
IPv6 addresses are not supported in the BIOS / TrustedCore setup utility.  
Ê
Call the BIOS / TrustedCore setup utility of the managed server. Do this by  
pressing [F2] while the server is booting.  
Ê
Call the LAN parameter configuration menu:  
BIOS: Advanced – IPMI – LAN Settings  
TrustedCore: Server – IPMI – LAN Settings  
Figure 8: LAN Settings menu (shown here for the TrustedCore setup utility)  
44  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
Ê
Configure the following settings:  
Service LAN  
Set the value to Enabled.  
Service LAN Port  
The Service setting is recommended.  
I
The Service setting is mandatory for the Type TX150 S6  
PRIMERGY server.  
DHCP  
If you enable DHCP, the iRMC S2 gets its LAN settings autonomously  
from a DHCP server on the network. In this case, the values for Local  
IP Address, Subnet Mask, etc. are set automatically.  
I
Do not activate the DHCP option if no DHCP server is  
available. If you activate the DHCP option and there is no  
DHCP server available, the iRMC S2 goes into a search loop  
(i.e. it constantly searches for a DHCP server).You can specify  
that the DHCP and DNS services are to be used after initial  
installation, using the iRMC S2 web interface, for instance (see  
By default, the following name is passed to the DHCP server  
on initial installation of the iRMC S3:  
iRMC<last 3 bytes of the MAC address>.  
Local IP Address  
Enter the IP address you have determined for the iRMC S2 of the  
managed system.  
Subnet Mask  
Enter the subnet mask for the network. the iRMC S2 is connected to.  
Gateway Address  
Specify the IP address of the gateway of the network the iRMC S2 is  
connected to.  
Ê
Save the settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
45  
Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
Ê
If you want to use console redirection on the iRMC S2 continue with section  
If you do not want to use text console redirection on the iRMC S2, exit the  
BIOS/TrustedCore setup and continue with the next section "Testing the LAN  
3.1.3.2 Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S3 by using the UEFI  
setup Utility  
Ê
Call the UEFI setup utility of the managed server. Do this by pressing [F2]  
while the server is booting.  
Ê
Call the iRMC LAN parameter configuration menu:  
Server Mgmt – iRMC LAN Parameters Configuration  
Figure 9: iRMC LAN Parameters Configuration Menu  
46  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring the LAN interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
Ê
Configure the following settings:  
Management LAN  
Set the value to Enabled.  
Management LAN Port  
I The Management setting is recommended.  
and/or refer to the manual "BIOS (Aptio) Setup Utility" manual  
corresponding to your server.  
For details on configuring the remaining settings see section  
Ê
Ê
Save the settings.  
If you want to use console redirection on the iRMC S3, continue with section  
If you do not want to use text console redirection on the iRMC S3, exit the  
UEFI setup and continue with the next section "Testing the LAN interface".  
3.1.4 Testing the LAN interface  
You can test the LAN interface as follows:  
Ê
Use a web browser to attempt to log into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface. If  
no login prompt appears, it is probable that the LAN interface is not working.  
Ê
Test the connection to the iRMC S2/S3 with a ping command.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
47  
   
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
3.2  
Configuring text console redirection via  
LAN using the BIOS / TrustedCore / UEFI  
setup utility  
Text console redirection will be available depending on the configuration of text  
console redirection and on the operating system of the server  
either for the duration of the BIOS POST phase only or  
beyond the BIOS POST phase while the operating system is running.  
This section describes:  
Configuration of text console redirection via LAN using the BIOS /  
TrustedCore setup utility (for iRMC S2)  
Configuration of text console redirection via LAN using the UEFI setup utility  
(for iRMC S3)  
Special requirements of the operating system used that you need to take  
account of if you also want to use console redirection while the operating  
system is running.  
I
You can also configure text console redirection via LAN using the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see section "BIOS Text Console - Configure  
48  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
3.2.1 Configuring text console redirection for the  
iRMC S2  
Ê
Call the BIOS / TrustedCore setup utility of the managed server. Do this by  
pressing [F2] while the server is booting.  
Settings in the Peripheral Configuration menu  
Ê
Call the Peripheral Configuration menu:  
Advanced – Peripheral Configuration  
Figure 10: Peripheral Configuration menu (as it appears in the TrustedCore setup utility)  
Ê
Configure the following settings:  
Serial 1  
Set the value to Enabled.  
Serial 1 Address  
Accept the first value pair proposed.  
Serial Multiplexer  
Set the value to iRMC.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
49  
 
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
Settings in the Console Redirection menu  
Ê
Call the Console Redirection menu:  
Server – Console Redirection  
I
The appearance of the Console Direction menu varies depending on  
the setup utility (BIOS or TrustedCore) you are using.  
Ê
Make the following settings in the BIOS setup utility:  
Figure 11: Console Redirection menu (as it appears in the BIOS setup utility)  
Console Redirection  
Set the value to Enabled.  
Port  
Set the value to Serial 1.  
Baud Rate  
Specify the baud rate.  
Protocol  
Leave this setting unchanged. (The setting depends on the terminal  
type used.)  
Flow Control  
Leave this setting unchanged. (The setting depends on the terminal  
type used.)  
50  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
Mode  
This setting affects the behavior of console redirection while the  
operating system is running (after the POST phase has completed) -  
Standard  
Console redirection is terminated after the BIOS POST phase.  
Enhanced  
Console redirection continues to be available after the BIOS  
POST phase.  
Ê
Make the following settings in the TrustedCore setup utility:  
Figure 12: Console Redirection menu (as it appears in the TrustedCore setup utility)  
Com Port Address  
Set the value to On-board COM A.  
Baud Rate  
Specify the baud rate.  
Console Type  
Leave this setting unchanged. (The setting depends on the terminal  
type used.)  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
51  
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
Flow Control  
The setting depends on the terminal type used. The settings must be  
the same on both terminal and managed server.  
Continue C.R. after POST:  
This setting affects the behavior of console redirection while the  
operating system is running (after the POST phase has completed) -  
Off  
Console redirection is terminated after the BIOS POST phase.  
On  
Console redirection continues to be available after the BIOS  
POST phase.  
Exiting the BIOS / TrustedCore setup utility  
Ê
Ê
Save your settings and exit the BIOS/TrustedCore setup utility.  
52  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
3.2.2 Configuring text console redirection for the  
iRMC S3  
Ê
Call the UEFI setup utility of the managed server. Do this by pressing [F2]  
while the server is booting.  
Ê
Call the Server Mgmt menu:  
Figure 13: Server Mgmt Menu  
Ê
Make the following settings:  
Serial Multiplexer  
Set the value to iRMCS3.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
53  
   
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
Ê
Call the Console Redirection menu:  
Figure 14: Console Redirection menu  
Ê
Make the following settings in the Console Redirection menu:  
Console Redirection  
Set the value to Serial 1. In this case, the terminal uses the first serial  
interface.  
Baud Rate  
Specify the baud rate.  
Protocol  
Leave this setting unchanged. (The setting depends on the terminal  
type used.)  
Flow Control  
The setting depends on the terminal type used. The settings must be  
the same on both terminal and managed server.  
Exiting the UEFI setup utility  
Ê
Ê
Save your settings and exit the UEFI setup utility.  
54  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
3.2.3 Using console redirection while the operating  
system is running  
Depending on the operating system used on the managed server, you can  
continue to use console redirection after the BIOS POST phase.  
DOS  
The BIOS setting for console redirection mode must be set as follows (see  
BIOS setup utility: Mode: Enhanced  
TrustedCore setup utility: Continue C.R. after POST: On  
Windows Server 2003 / 2008  
I
If activated during Windows installation, console redirection is thereby  
automatically configured.  
If console redirection is activated after Windows installation has  
completed, you must configure console redirection manually.  
Windows Server 2003 / 2008 handles console redirection automatically after the  
POST phase. No further settings are necessary. While the operating system is  
booting, the Windows Server 2003 SAC console is transferred:  
Figure 15: Windows Server 2003 SAC console  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
55  
 
Configuring text console redirection via LAN  
Linux  
You must configure a Linux operating system in such a way that it handles  
console redirection after the POST phase. Once it has been configured, you  
have unrestricted access from the remote workstation.  
Settings required  
The settings may differ between program versions.  
SuSe and RedHat  
Add the following line to the end of the file /etc/inittab:  
xx:12345:respawn:/sbin/agetty <baud-rate> ttyS0  
RedHat  
Insert the following kernel boot parameter in the file /etc/grub.conf:  
console=ttyS0,<baud-rate> console=tty0  
SuSE  
Insert the following kernel boot parameter in the file /boot/grub/menu.lst :  
console=ttyS0,<baud-rate> console=tty0  
56  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring and using the serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
3.3  
Configuring and using the serial interface  
of the iRMC S2/S3  
The serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3 offers you the following possibilities:  
You can use the terminal application Remote Manager (Serial) over a null  
In the case of an iRMC S2, you can forward alerts via modem. You can  
configure alerting via modem using the web interface of the iRMC S2 (see  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
57  
 
Configuring and using the serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
3.3.1 Configuring the serial interface of the iRMC S2  
Ê
Call the BIOS / TrustedCore setup utility of the managed server. Do this by  
pressing [F2] while the server is booting.  
Ê
Call the Peripheral Configuration menu to configure the serial port:  
Advanced – Peripheral Configuration  
Figure 16: Peripheral Configuration menu (as it appears in the TrustedCore setup utility)  
Ê
Configure the following settings:  
Serial 1  
Set the value to Enabled.  
Serial 1 Address  
Accept the first value pair proposed.  
Serial Multiplexer  
Set the value to iRMC.  
58  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring and using the serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
The following values are not shown in the menu and are preset (see  
page 62, “Terminal program (VT100+)”):  
Bits per second  
9600  
Data bits  
8
Parity  
None.  
Stop bits  
1
Flow Control  
None  
Exiting the BIOS / TrustedCore setup utility  
Ê
Ê
Save your settings and exit the BIOS/TrustedCore setup utility.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
59  
Configuring and using the serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
3.3.2 Configuring the serial interface using of the  
iRMC S3  
Ê
Call the UEFI setup utility of the managed server. Do this by pressing [F2]  
while the server is booting.  
Ê
Call the Server Mgmt menu:  
Figure 17: Server Mgmt menu  
Ê
Ê
Configure the following settings:  
Serial Multiplexer  
Set the value to iRMCS3.  
Call the Serial Port 1 Configuration menu to configure the serial port:  
Advanced – Super IO Configuration – Serial Port 1 Configuration:  
60  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring and using the serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
Figure 18: Serial Port 1 Configuration menu  
Ê
Configure the following settings:  
Serial Port  
Set the value to Enabled.  
Device Settings  
Displays the base I/O address and the interrupt used to access the  
corresponding serial port, e.g. IO=3F8h; IRQ=4.  
Accept the value pair proposed.  
The following values are not shown in the menu and are preset (see  
page 62, “Terminal program (VT100+)”):  
Bits per second  
9600  
Data bits  
8
Parity  
None.  
Stop bits  
1
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
61  
Configuring and using the serial interface of the iRMC S2/S3  
Flow Control  
None  
Exiting the UEFI setup utility  
Ê
Ê
Save your settings and exit the UEFI setup utility.  
3.3.3 Using the Remote Manager (Serial) interface  
If you connect a computer over a null modem cable and start a terminal program  
(VT100+) on this computer, you can access the Remote Manager (Serial)  
terminal program. The Remote Manager (Serial) interface is identical to the  
Remote Manager interface (see chapter "iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet/SSH (Remote  
Prerequisites  
On the managed server:  
The Serial Multiplexer BIOS setting must be configured on the iRMC (see  
Terminal program (VT100+):  
Configure the following port settings for the terminal program:  
Bits per second  
Set the value to 9600.  
Data bits  
Set the value to 8.  
Parity  
Set the value to None.  
Stop bits  
Set the value to 1.  
Flow Control  
Set the value to None.  
62  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 over the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
3.4  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 over the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Ê
Start the iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see section "Logging into the  
3.4.1 Configuring the LAN parameters  
Ê
In the navigation area, click Network Settings (see section "Network Settings  
Configuring the LAN settings  
Ê
Configure the LAN settings on the Network Interface page. See the section  
S2/S3" on page 239 for the settings required.  
Configuring ports and network services  
Ê
Configure the ports and network services on the Ports and Network Services  
network services" on page 245 for the settings required.  
Configuring DHCP/DNS (Dynamic DNS)  
Ê
Configure the DHCP and DNS settings in the DNS Configuration page. See  
page 249 for the settings required.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
63  
   
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 over the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
3.4.2 Configuring alerting  
The pages for configuring alerting are grouped in the navigation area under  
Configuring alert forwarding over SNMP  
Ê
Ê
In the navigation area, click SNMP Traps. The SNMP Traps page appears.  
Configure SNMP trap forwarding. See the section "SNMP Trap Alerting -  
Configure SNMP trap alerting" on page 254 for the settings required.  
Configuring alert forwarding to a mobile phone via modem  
(only with the iRMC S2)  
Ê
In the navigation area, click Serial / Modem. The Serial / Modem Alerting page  
appears.  
Ê
Configure alert forwarding via modem. See the section "Serial / Modem  
required.  
Configuring email notification (email alerting)  
Ê
Ê
In the navigation area, click Email. The Email Alerting page appears.  
Configure email alerting. See the section "Email Alerting - Configure email  
alerting" on page 257 for the settings required.  
3.4.3 Configuring text console redirection  
Ê
Configure text console redirection in the BIOS Text Console window. See the  
on page 292 for the settings required.  
64  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
User management for the  
iRMC S2/S3  
User management for the iRMC S2/S3 uses two different types of user  
identifications:  
Local user identifications are stored locally in the iRMC S2/S3’s non-  
volatile storage and are managed via the iRMC S2/S3 user interfaces.  
Global user identifications are stored in the central data store of a  
directory service and are managed via this directory service’s interfaces.  
The following directory services are currently supported for global  
iRMC S2/S3 user management:  
Microsoft® Active Directory  
Novell® eDirectory  
OpenLDAP  
OpenDS  
This chapter provides information on the following topics:  
User management concept for the iRMC S2/S3  
User permissions  
Local user management on the iRMC S2/S3  
I
For detailed information on the global user management using the  
individual directory services, please refer to the "User Management in  
ServerView" manual.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
65  
   
Concept  
4.1  
User management concept for the  
iRMC S2/S3  
User management for the iRMC S2/S3 permits the parallel administration of  
local and global user identifications.  
When validating the authentication data (user name, password) which users  
enter when logging in to one of the iRMC S2/S3 interfaces, iRMC S2/S3  
proceeds as follows (see also figure 19 on page 67):  
1. The iRMC S2/S3 compares the user name and password with the locally  
stored user identifications:  
If the user is authenticated successfully by iRMC S2/S3 (user name and  
password are valid) then the user can log in.  
Otherwise, the iRMC S2/S3 continues the verification with step 2.  
2. The iRMC S2/S3 authenticates itself at the directory service via LDAP with  
a user name and password, determines the user rights by means of an  
LDAP query and checks whether the user is authorized to work with these  
at the iRMC S2/S3.  
66  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Concept  
iRMC S2/S3 web  
interface  
Serial  
interface  
SSH  
Telnet  
Login  
Login  
Login  
Login  
SSL  
SSH  
User name, password  
SSL  
SSH  
iRMC S2/S3  
local user identifications  
SSL  
User name, password  
SSL  
LDAP login  
Directory service  
Global user identifications  
Bild 19: Login authentication via the iRMC S2/S3  
I
Although optional, the use of SSL for the LDAP connection between the  
iRMC S2/S3 and directory service is recommended. An SSL-secured  
LDAP connection between iRMC S2/S3 and the directory service  
guarantees secure data exchange, and in particular the secure transfer  
of the user name and password data.  
SSL login via the iRMC S2/S3 web interface is only required if LDAP is  
active (LDAP enable option, see page 274).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
67  
 
User permissions  
4.2  
User permissions  
The iRMC S2/S3 distinguishes between two mutually complementary types of  
user permissions:  
Channel-specific privileges (via assignment to channel-specific permission  
groups)  
Permissions to use special iRMC S2/S3 functions  
I
The privileges and permissions required for the use of the individual  
iRMC S2/S3 functions are described  
for the iRMC S2/S3-web interface, on page 138,  
for the Remote Manager, on page 330.  
Channel-specific privileges (channel-specific permission groups)  
The iRMC S2/S3 assigns each user identification to one of the following four  
channel-specific permission groups:  
users  
Operator  
Administrator  
OEM  
Since iRMC S2/S3 assigns these permissions on a channel-specific basis,  
users can have different permissions, depending on whether they access the  
iRMC S2/S3 over the LAN interface or the serial interface.  
The scope of permissions granted increases from User (lowest permission level)  
through Operator and Administrator up to OEM (highest permission level).  
I
The permission groups correspond to the IPMI privilege level. Certain  
permissions (e.g. for Power Management) are associated with these  
groups or privilege levels.  
68  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
User permissions  
Permissions to use special iRMC S2/S3 functions  
In addition to the channel-specific permissions, you can also individually assign  
users the following permissions:  
Configure User Accounts  
Permission to configure local user identifications  
Configure iRMC S2/S3 Settings  
Permission to configure the iRMC S2/S3 settings.  
Video Redirection Enabled  
Permission to use Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) in “View Only” and  
“Full Control” mode  
Remote Storage Enabled  
Permission to use the Remote Storage functionality  
Preconfigured user ID  
The firmware of the iRMC S2/S3 provides a default administrator ID for the  
iRMC S2/S3 which possesses all permissions:  
Administrator ID:  
Password:  
admin  
admin  
I
Both the administrator ID and the password are case-sensitive in the  
case of local users.  
It is urgently recommended that you create a new administrator account  
as soon as possible once you have logged in, and then delete the default  
administrator account or at least change the password for the account  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
69  
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
4.3  
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
The iRMC S2/S3 possesses its own local user management. Up to 16 users to  
be configured with passwords and be assigned various rights depending on the  
user groups they belong to. The user identifications are stored in the  
iRMC S2/S3’s local, non-volatile storage.  
The following options are available for user management on the iRMC S2/S3:  
User management via the web interface  
User management via the Server Configuration Manager  
4.3.1 Local user management using the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
I
User management on the iRMC S2/S3 requires Configure User Accounts  
permission.  
You can view a list of configured users under the web interface. You can also  
configure new users, change the configuration of existing users and remove  
users from the list.  
Ê
Start the iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see section "Logging into the  
Showing the list of configured users  
Ê
In the navigation area, click the User Management - iRMC S2/S3 User function.  
The User Management page opens containing a list of configured users (see  
page 264). Here, you can delete users and call the page for configuring new  
users.  
This page is described in section "User Management" on page 263.  
70  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
Configuring new users  
On the User Management page, click the New User button.  
Ê
The New User Configuration page opens. This page allows you to configure  
the basic settings for the new user. This page is described in section "New  
Modifying the configuration of a user  
Ê
On the User Management page, click the name of the user whose  
configuration parameters you want to change.  
The User “<name>” Configuration page opens showing the settings for the  
selected user. Here, you can change the configuration parameters for the  
new user. This page is described in section "User “<name>” Configuration -  
Deleting users  
Ê
On the User Management page, click on the Delete button in the same line as  
the user to be deleted.  
4.3.2 Local user management via the Server  
Configuration Manager  
I
Prerequisite:  
I The current ServerView agents must be installed on the managed server.  
User management on the iRMC S2/S3 requires Configure User Accounts  
permission.  
User management via the Server Configuration Manager largely conforms to  
user management using the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
on page 347 is described how to start the Server Configuration Manager.  
For details on the individual Configuration Manager dialogs, please refer to the  
online help of the Server Configuration Manager.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
71  
 
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
4.3.3 SSHv2 public key authentication for iRMC S2/S3  
users  
In addition to authentication by means of a user name and password, the  
iRMC S2/S3 also supports SSHv2-based public key authentication using pairs  
of public and private keys for local users. To implement SSHv2 public key  
authentication, the SSHv2 key of an iRMC S2/S3 user is uploaded to the  
iRMC S2/S3 and the iRMC S2/S3 user uses their private key with the program  
PuTTY or the OpenSSH client program ssh, for example.  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports the following types of public keys:  
SSH DSS (minimum requirement)  
SSH RSA (recommended)  
The public SSHv2 keys that you upload to the iRMC S2/S3 can be available  
either in RFC4716 format or in OpenSSH format (see page 84).  
Public key authentication  
In outline, public key authentication of a user on the iRMC S2/S3 happens as  
follows:  
The user who wishes to log into the iRMC S2/S3 creates the key pair:  
The private key is read-protected and remains on the user's computer.  
The user (or administrator) uploads the public key to the iRMC S2/S3.  
If the configuration allows this, the user can now log into the iRMC S2/S3  
extremely securely and without the need to enter a password. The user is only  
responsible for keeping their private key secret.  
The following steps are necessary to set up private key authentication. They are  
described in the subsequent sections:  
1. Creating the public and private SSHv2 keys with the program PuTTYgen or  
ssh-keygen and saving them in separate files (see page 73).  
2. Loading the public SSHv2 key onto the iRMC S2/S3 from a file  
(see page 77).  
3. Configuring the program PuTTY or ssh for SSHv2 access to the iRMC S2/S3  
(see page 79).  
72  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
4.3.3.1 reating public and private SSHv2 keys  
You can create public and private SSHv2 keys  
with the program PuTTYgen or  
with the OpenSSH client program ssh-keygen.  
Creating the public and private SSHv2 keys with PuTTYgen  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Start PuTTYgen on your Windows computer.  
The following window appears when PuTTYgen is started:  
Bild 20: PuTTYgen: Creating new private and public SSHv2 keys  
Ê
Under Parameters, select the key type SSH-2RSA and click Generate to start  
generation of the keys.  
The progress of the generation operation is then displayed under Key (see  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
73  
 
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
Bild 21: PuTTYgen: Creating a new key pair (progress bar).  
Ê
Move the mouse pointer over the blank area of the progress display to  
increase the randomness of the generated keys.  
When the keys have been generated, PuTTYgen displays the key and the  
fingerprint of the public SSHv2 key:  
Bild 22: PuTTYgen: Creating a new private SSHv2 key (progress bar).  
Ê
Ê
Click Save public key to save the public SSHv2 key to a file. You can upload  
the public key to the iRMC S2/S3 from this file (see page 77).  
Click Save private key to save the private SSHv2 key to a file for use with  
PuTTY (see page 79).  
74  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
Creating the public and private SSHv2 keys with ssh-keygen  
I
If it is not already pre-installed in the Linux distribution you are using, you  
can obtain OpenSSH from http://www.openssh.org.  
You will find a detailed description of the operands in the OpenSSH  
OpenSSH manual pages under http://www.openssh.org/manual.html  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Call ssh-keygen to generate an RSA key pair:  
ssh-keygen -t rsa  
ssh-keygen logs the progress of the key generation operation. ssh-keygen  
queries the user for the file name under which the private key is to be stored  
and for the passphrase for the private key. ssh-keygen stores the resulting  
private and public SSHv2 keys in separate files and displays the fingerprint  
of the public key.  
Example: Generating an RSA key pair with ssh -keygen  
1
2
3
4
5
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
75  
 
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
Explanation:  
1. ssh-keygen requests the file name under which the SSHv2 key is to be  
saved. If you press [Enter] to confirm without entering a file name,  
ssh-keygen uses the default file name id_rsa.  
2. ssh-keygen requests you to enter a passphrase (and to confirm it) that  
is used to encrypt the private key. If you press [Enter] to confirm  
without entering a passphrase, ssh-keygen does not use a passphrase.  
3. ssh-keygen informs the user that the newly generated private SSHv2  
key has been saved in the file /.ssh/id_rsa.  
4. ssh-keygen informs the user that the newly generated public SSHv2  
key has been saved in the file /.ssh/id_rsa.pub.  
5. ssh-keygen displays the fingerprint of the public SSHv2 key and the  
local login to which the public key belongs.  
76  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
4.3.3.2 Loading the public SSHv2 key onto the iRMC S2/S3 from a file  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Under the iRMC S2/S3 web interface, open the detailed view for the required  
browser (in this case user3) iRMC S2/S3 User Management page:  
(1)  
(2)  
Bild 23: iRMC S2/S3 web interface: Loading the public SSHv2 key onto the iRMC S2/S3  
Ê
Click Browse in the group User SSHv2 public key upload from file (1) and  
navigate to the file containing the required public key (2).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
77  
 
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
Ê
Click Upload to load the public key onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
After the key has been successfully uploaded, the iRMC S2/S3 displays the  
key fingerprint in the group User SSHv2 public key upload from file:  
Key type  
Key length  
MD5 fingerprint of the saved key  
Bild 24: Display of the key fingerprint  
I
For reasons of security, make sure that the fingerprint shown here  
matches that shown in PuTTYgen (see figure 22 on page 74) under  
Key fingerprint.  
78  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
4.3.3.3 Configuring PuTTY and the OpenSSH client for using the public  
SSHv2 key  
Configuring PuTTY for using the public SSHv2 key  
The PuTTY program allows you to set up a public-key-authenticated connection  
to the iRMC S2/S3 and log in either under your user name or using the auto-  
login mechanism. PuTTY handles the authentication protocol automatically on  
the basis of the public/private SSHv2 key pair previously generated.  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Start PuTTY on your Windows computer.  
The following window appears when PuTTY is started:  
Bild 25: PuTTY: Selecting and loading an SSH session  
Ê
Select a saved SSH session or create a new SSH session for the  
iRMC S2/S3 for which you want to use the SSHv2 key.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
79  
 
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
Ê
Click Load to load the selected SSH session.  
This opens the following window:  
Bild 26: PuTTY: Loading an SSH session  
Ê
Choose SSH - Auth to configure the SSH authentication options.  
This opens the following window (see figure 27 on page 81).  
80  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
Bild 27: Configuring the SSH authentication options  
Ê
Select the file containing the private key that you want to use with the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
I
Please note:  
At this point, you require the private key (see page 74) and not the  
public key that you loaded onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
81  
 
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
I
Under Connection - Data, you can additionally specify a user name for  
automatic login onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Bild 28: PuTTY: Specifying the user name for automatically logging into the iRMC  
S2/S3  
Configuring the OpenSSH client program ssh for using the public SSHv2  
key  
You establish an SSHv2-protected connection to the iRMC S2/S3 using the  
OpenSSH client program ssh. You can log in either under your current local login  
or under a different login.  
I
The login must have been configured as a local login on the iRMC S2/S3  
and the associated SSHv2 key must have been loaded on the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
ssh reads its configuration options in order from the following sources:  
1. Command line arguments that you specify when calling ssh:  
2. User-specific configuration file ($HOME/.ssh/config)  
82  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
I
Although this file contains no security-critical information, read/write  
permission should only be granted to the owner. Access should be  
denied to all other users.  
3. System-wide configuration file (/etc/ssh/ssh_config)  
This file contains default values for configuration parameters  
if there is no user-specific configuration file or  
if the relevant parameters are not specified in the user-specific  
configuration file.  
The value found first applies for each option.  
I
You will find detailed information on the configuration of ssh and on its  
operands on the manual pages for OpenSSH under  
http://www.openssh.org/manual.html  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Start ssh, to log in to the iRMC S2/S3 under SSHv2-authentication:  
ssh -l [<user>] <iRMC_S2/S3>  
or  
ssh [<user>@]<iRMC_S2/S3>  
<user>  
User name under which you want to log into the iRMC S2/S3. If you  
do not specify <user>, ssh uses the user name under which you are  
logged into your local computer to log you in to iRMC S2/S3.  
<iRMC_S2/S3>  
iRMC S2/S3 name or IP address of the iRMC S2/S3 you want to log  
into.  
Example: SSHv2-authenticated login on the iRMC S2/S3  
For the following ssh- call, it is assumed that ssh-keygen has been used to  
generate a public/private RSA key pair as described under "Example:  
public key User1/.ssh/id_rsa.pub has been loaded onto the iRMC S2/S3 for an  
iRMC S2/S3 user user4 (see page 77).  
You can then log in from your local computer under $HOME/User1 as follows  
on the iRMC S2 "RX100_S52-iRMC" using the login user4:  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
83  
Local user management for the iRMC S2/S3  
ssh user4@RX100_S52-iRMC  
4.3.3.4 Example: Public SSHv2 key  
The following shows the same public SSHv2 key in both RFC4716 format and  
in OpenSSH format.  
Public SSHv2 key in RFC4716 format  
---- BEGIN SSH2 PUBLIC KEY ----  
Comment: "rsa-key-20090401"  
AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAABJQAAAIBScBsgP9B74qNa9+w8Ccv3kDVVu2boKCGLv4hx  
v6+AUFrF6sYdGey1QQ7MkwSeax3NmoZBkvkR9hNfZSqxkPCkd//LyUil9US5/9Ar  
JxjlhXUzlPPVzuBtPaRB7+bISTJVMUorNwrcN48b6AAoYBhKC4AOtOP1OGsfc+F  
pGJ2iw==  
---- END SSH2 PUBLIC KEY ----  
Public SSHv2 key in OpenSSH format  
ssh-rsa  
AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAABJQAAAIBScBsgP9B74qNa9+w8Ccv3kDVVu2boKCGLv4hx  
v6+AUFrF6sYdGey1QQ7MkwSeax3NmoZBkvkR9hNfZSqxkPCkd//LyUil9US5/9Ar  
JxjlhXUzlPPVzuBtPaRB7+bISTJVMUorNwrcN48b6AAoYBhKC4AOtOP1OGwsfc+F  
pGJ2iw== rsa-key-20090401  
84  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5
Advanced Video Redirection  
(AVR)  
I
A valid license key is required to use the Advanced Video Redirection  
function.  
Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) allows you to control the mouse and  
keyboard of the managed server from your remote workstation and to show the  
current graphical and text output from the managed server.  
I
The AVR Java applet allows you to use the Remote Storage function  
This chapter provides information on the following topics:  
Checking the AVR settings  
Using AVR  
Menus of the AVR window  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
85  
   
Prerequisites  
5.1  
Requirements:  
Check the AVR settings  
Check the following important settings before using AVR:  
Graphics mode settings on the managed server  
AVR supports the following graphics modes:  
Resolution  
Refresh rates  
[in Hz]  
Maximum  
color depth  
[bits]  
640 x 480 (VGA)  
800 x 600 (SVGA)  
1024 x 768 (XGA)  
1152 x 864  
60; 75; 85  
32  
56; 60; 72; 75; 85 32  
60; 70; 75; 85  
60; 70; 75  
32  
32  
16  
24  
16  
16  
16  
16  
1280 x 1024 (UXGA) 60; 70; 75; 85  
1280 x 1024 (UXGA) 60  
1600 x 1200 (UXGA) 60; 65  
1680 x 10501  
1920 x 10801  
1920 x 12001  
60  
60  
60  
Table 3: Supported display settings  
1
iRMC S3 only  
I
If a high-resolution graphics mode is set on the server (shown on a gray  
I background in the table), this is shown on the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
Only VESA-compliant graphics modes are supported.  
86  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Prerequisites  
Supported text mode  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports the following common text modes:  
40 x 25  
80 x 25  
80 x 43  
80 x 50  
Refer to the Help system for your operating system for information on the display  
settings.  
Keyboard settings  
I
The keyboard settings must be identical:  
on the remote workstation,  
on the managed server,  
on the iRMC S2/S3.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
87  
Using AVR  
5.2  
Using AVR  
Ê
To start AVR, click the Start Video Redirection or Start Video Redirection (Java  
Web Start) button on the Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) page of the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see page 302).  
The Advanced Video Redirection window (AVR window) opens, showing you  
the display on the managed server.  
The AVR window also contains the following elements:  
Menu bar: The Preferences and Extras menus allow you to configure the  
AVR settings and to control the AVR (see page 101). Remote Storage is  
used to call the remote storage function (see page 105).  
Languages (see page 107) menu allows you to set the language  
(German/English) in which the menus and dialog boxes of the AVR  
window are to be shown.  
Integrated special keys (see page 91).  
The Local Monitor <status> indicator shows whether the local monitor of  
the managed server is switched on (see section "Local Monitor Off"  
Menu bar  
Integrated special keys  
Local Monitor <status>  
Figure 29: Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) window  
88  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using AVR  
5.2.1 Using a low bandwidth  
In the case of a reduced data transfer rate, you can configure a lower bandwidth  
(bits per pixel, bpp) in terms of color depth for your current AVR session (see  
5.2.2 Parallel AVR sessions  
AVR can be used by two user sessions simultaneously. One user has full control  
over the server (full-control mode) and the other can only passively observe  
keyboard and mouse operation of the server (view only mode).  
When AVR is first started, you are initially in view only mode. You will always be  
asked if you want to switch to full-control mode. If you decide to switch to full-  
control mode and another full-control mode session is already active, the  
existing session is switched to view-only mode.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
89  
   
Using AVR  
5.2.3 Local Monitor Off" function  
The Local Monitor Off function of the iRMC S2/S3 allows you to power down the  
local monitor of the managed server for the duration of your AVR session. In this  
way, you ensure that the inputs you make and the actions you perform on the  
local monitor on the server using AVR cannot be seen. The identification LED  
flashes to indicate "Local Monitor Off" mode on the server.  
You configure the “Local Monitor Off” function on the Advanced Video Redirection  
page of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see page 302). After you have  
configured the system appropriately, you can switch the local monitor of the  
server on and off from the remote workstation as follows:  
In Full Control mode in an AVR session using the Extras menu  
directly on the Advanced Video Redirection page with administrator or OEM  
permissions  
You can also configure that the local monitor is always switched off  
automatically whenever a new AVR session is started.  
The current status of the local monitor is shown in the AVR window in blue  
letters to the top right of the integrated special keys:  
The local monitor is always switched on and cannot be switched off, as  
the Enable Local Monitor Off option (see page 307) is deactivated.  
Local Monitor On  
The local monitor is on, but can be switched off.  
Local Monitor Off  
The local monitor is off, but can be switched on.  
Local Monitor always off  
The local monitor is always switched off and cannot be switched on  
because a high-resolution graphics mode has been set on the managed  
server (see table 3 on page 86).  
90  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using AVR  
5.2.4 Redirecting the keyboard  
Keyboard redirection only works when the focus is on the AVR window.  
Ê
If keyboard redirection appears not to be working, simply click on the AVR  
window.  
Ê
If the keyboard does not respond, check that the AVR window is not in view-  
only mode. How to switch to full-control mode is described on page 103.  
Special key combinations  
AVR passes all normal key combinations to the server. Special keys such as  
Windows keys are not sent. Some special key combinations suchas [ALT] +  
[F4] cannot be sent, because they are interrupted by the client’s operating  
system. In such cases, you should use the integrated special keys or the virtual  
keyboard.  
Integrated special keys  
Below the menu bar of the AVR window, you will find a bar containing the special  
keys. These keys are implemented as “sticky keys”, i.e. they remain pressed  
when you click them and only return to their normal position when you click them  
again.  
Using the integrated special keys, you can, for instance, use Windows keys or  
special key combinations which are not sent by AVR if you press them on your  
own keyboard.  
Figure 30: AVR window - integrated special keys  
[Mouse Sync]  
Press this key to synchronize the mouse pointers (see also section  
[Ctrl]  
Left CTRL key (corresponds to the [Ctrl] key on your keyboard).  
[Alt]  
Alt(ernate) key (corresponds to the [Alt] key on your keyboard).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
91  
   
Using AVR  
[Win]  
Left and right Windows keys (correspond to the keys on your keyboard  
between the left and right [Ctrl] and [Alt ] keys).  
[Alt Gr]  
Alt(ernate) Gr(aphic) key (corresponds to the [Alt Gr] key on your  
keyboard).  
[Context]  
Context menu for the selected object (corresponds to the key  
combination [Shift] + [F10] on your keyboard).  
[Lock]  
Caps lock (corresponds to the [Caps Lock] key on your keyboard).  
[Ctrl-Alt-Del]  
Corresponds to the key combination [Ctrl]+ [Alt] + [Del] on your  
keyboard.  
Virtual keyboard  
The virtual keyboard (see figure 31) provides you with a functional  
representation of the keyboard. All key combinations are available when you  
use the virtual keyboard. This means that you can use the virtual keyboard as  
a fully functional replacement for a real keyboard.  
You activate the virtual keyboard in the AVR window from the Extras menu (see  
Figure 31: Virtual Keyboard (keyboard layout: German (DE))  
92  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using AVR  
Secure Keyboard  
If you are connected to the iRMC S2/S3 web interface over an HTTPS  
connection, entries at the keyboard are transferred over a secure SSL  
connection.  
5.2.5 Redirecting the mouse  
The mouse pointer on the managed server is moved synchronously with the  
mouse on the remote workstation. You configure the mouse redirection settings  
in the AVR window under Mouse Mode in the Preferences menu (see page 108).  
5.2.5.1 Synchronizing the mouse pointer  
When the AVR window is first opened, it is possible that the mouse pointer on  
the remote workstation (local mouse pointer) is not yet synchronized with the  
mouse pointer on the managed server.  
To synchronize the two mouse pointers, use one of the following alternatives  
Ê
Ê
Click [Mouse Sync] in the menu bar of the AVR window.  
Move the local mouse pointer to the top left corner of the AVR window. The  
mouse pointer on the managed server automatically follows this movement.  
The pointers are synchronized when the two mouse pointers completely  
overlap.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
93  
     
Using AVR  
(3)  
(1)  
(2)  
Press the Mouse Sync key  
or  
(1) Drag the local mouse cursor to the top left corner.  
(2) The server’s mouse pointer follows automatically.  
(3) The mouse pointers are synchronized when they completely  
overlap and e displayed as a single mouse pointer.  
Figure 32: Synchronizing the local mouse pointer and the mouse pointer of the managed  
server  
I
Correct synchronization of the mouse pointers requires that certain  
settings are made on the managed server. If the managed server has  
been installed using the ServerView Installation Manager these settings  
has been preconfigured automatically by the Matrox VGA installation.  
If synchronization of the mouse pointers does not function correctly, for  
instance because the preconfigured settings have been changed, you  
can restore correct synchronization of the mouse pointers by making the  
settings described below. The settings must be made on the managed  
server.  
94  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using AVR  
I
The settings for the mouse pointer synchronization are supported only  
for the operating system which runs the managed server.  
If the software which controls the mouse is active, sometimes the mouse  
pointer cannot be synchronized.  
5.2.5.2 Managed Windows server:  
Adjusting the settings for synchronization of the mouse pointers  
On a Windows server, you can either make the settings for mouse pointer  
synchronization using a batch program or using the Windows Start menu and  
the context menu.  
You must adjust the following settings:  
Speed of the mouse pointer  
Hardware acceleration  
I
When you adjust the settings using a batch program, the Matrox graphics  
driver is installed as well as the mouse pointer speed and hardware  
acceleration being adjusted.  
You can make all the settings for the managed server either directly at the  
managed server or from the remote workstation over AVR.  
Adjusting the settings on the managed server using a batch program  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Ê
Open a DOS prompt window.  
Switch to the folder in which the batch program install_kronos2_vga.bat for  
the relevant Matrox VGA driver installation (32-bit or 64-bit) is located.  
I
By default, you will find the install_kronos2_vga.bat programs under:  
C:\Program Files\Fujitsu\ServerView Suite\Installation Manager\  
Content\V10.09.12.00\DRV\VIDEO\MATROX\iRMC\W2K  
and on your ServerView Suite DVD 1.  
Ê
Ê
Type setup.bat to start the batch program.  
Reboot the managed server when the batch program has executed.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
95  
   
Using AVR  
Adjusting the settings on the managed server using the Windows Start  
menu and the context menu  
Proceed as follows to adjust the mouse pointer:  
Ê
Choose  
Start - Settings - Control Panel - Printers and Other Hardware - Mouse and  
choose the Pointer Options tab.  
This opens the following window:  
Figure 33: Mouse Properties - Pointer Options  
Ê
Ê
Ê
Set the Pointer Speed to a medium value.  
Disable the Enhance Pointer Precision option.  
Click the [OK] button to save the settings.  
96  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using AVR  
Proceed as follows to adjust the hardware acceleration:  
Ê
Ê
Right-click on the desktop background.  
In the context menu that appears, choose:  
Properties - Settings tab, Advanced button, and the Troubleshooting tab.  
This opens the following window:  
Figure 34: Properties - ... - Troubleshooting: Hardware acceleration  
Ê
Ê
Set the Hardware Acceleration to a value as shown in figure 34.  
Click the [OK] button to save the settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
97  
 
Using AVR  
5.2.5.3 Managed Linux server:  
Adjusting the settings for synchronization of the mouse pointers  
Prerequisite: The managed server is running under one of the following Linux  
operating systems:  
Red Hat 4.x  
Red Hat 5.x  
Suse 9.x  
Suse 10.x  
Suse 11.x  
Different graphical user interfaces (GUIs) are available for Suse Linux and  
Redhat Linux. The most important GUIs are:  
Gnome  
KDE  
You can adjust the mouse pointer synchronization settings on the managed  
server either using commands or under menu guidance.  
You must adjust the following settings:  
Mouse motion acceleration = 1  
Mouse motion threshold =1  
You can make all the settings for the managed server either directly at the  
managed server or from the remote workstation over AVR.  
Adjusting temporary settings on the managed server using commands  
Use the xset command to make the settings for Pointer acceleration and Pointer  
threshold (recommended values: 1 in each case) for the duration of the current  
session.  
Command syntax:  
xset m(ouse)][acceleration][threshold]  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Ê
Call a command line tool.  
Run the command xset with the following arguments:  
xset m 1 1  
98  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using AVR  
Adjusting permanent settings on the managed server using a  
configuration file (KDE)  
You make permanent settings as follows for KDE:  
Ê
Change the settings in the text file /root/.kde/share/config/kcminputrc as  
follows:  
[Mouse]  
Acceleration=1  
Threshold=1  
I
It is not necessary to set the values again after rebooting the server.  
Adjusting the permanent settings on the managed server under menu  
guidance  
I
It is not necessary to set the values again after rebooting the server.  
You make permanent settings as follows for KDE:  
I
The procedure for KDE described below only applies to Suse Linux.  
Ê
Choose  
N - Control Center - Peripheral - Mouse - Advanced tab  
The Mouse - Control Center window opens:  
Figure 35: Mouse Control Center window  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
99  
Using AVR  
Ê
Set the following values in the Mouse Control Center window:  
Pointer acceleration: 1.0x (minimum value)  
Pointer threshold: 20 pixels (maximum value)  
Ê
Ê
Save the settings.  
Reboot the managed server.  
I
It is not necessary to set the values again after rebooting the server.  
You make permanent settings as follows for Gnome:  
Ê
Ê
Ê
Call the gconf-editor editor under the shell.  
Choose: desktop - gnome - peripherals - mouse  
Modify the following attribute values:  
motion_acceleration 1  
motion_threshold 1  
100  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Menus of the AVR window  
5.3  
Menus of the AVR window  
The menu bar of the AVR window contains the following menus:  
The Extras menu allows you to control the AVR session. You can also make  
a virtual keyboard available.  
You can set up and clear remote storage connections with the Remote Storage  
menu.  
The Power Control menu allows you to power the server up/down or to reboot  
the server.  
The Languages menu allows you to set the language (German/English) used  
to display the AVR menus and dialogs.  
The Preferences menu allows you to configure the mouse, keyboard and  
logging settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
101  
 
Menus of the AVR window  
5.3.1 Extras menu  
You can select the following functions in the Extras menu:  
Figure 36: AVR window - Extras menu  
Virtual Keyboard ...  
The Virtual Keyboard window opens (see figure 31 on page 92).  
Update local monitor state  
Refreshes the display of the local monitor state.  
Turn local monitor on  
Switches on the local monitor of the managed server.  
I
This function is disabled in the following cases, even if the local  
monitor is switched off:  
you are in view-only mode,  
A high-resolution graphics mode is set on the managed server  
Local monitor <status> display:  
Local Monitor always off  
102  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Menus of the AVR window  
Turn local monitor off  
Switches off the local monitor of the managed server.  
I
This function is disabled in the following cases, even if the local  
monitor is switched on:  
you are in view-only mode,  
When AVR was started, the Local Monitor Off option was not  
enabled under Local Monitor (see page 306).  
Local monitor <status> display:  
Local Monitor always on  
Refresh Screen  
Refreshes the AVR window.  
Take Full Control...  
Switch to full-control mode. (This function is disabled if you are already  
in full-control mode.)  
I
An already existing full-control session will be notified by the  
notified. If the currently existing full-control session refuses your  
attempt to take full control, your session will remain in view-only  
mode.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
103  
   
Menus of the AVR window  
Disconnect Session...  
Terminate another AVR session.  
I
It is only possible to terminate other AVR sessions with  
Disconnect Session. To terminate your own session, choose Exit.  
A list of current AVR sessions appears:  
Figure 37: Extras menu - Disconnect Session  
Ê
Ê
Select the AVR session that you wish to terminate.  
Click OK to confirm that you want to terminate the selected AVR  
session.  
Ê
Click Cancel if you do not want to terminate the selected AVR session.  
Relinquish Full Control...  
Switch to view-only mode. (This function is disabled if you are already in  
view-only mode.)  
Exit  
Terminate your own AVR session.  
104  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Menus of the AVR window  
5.3.2 Remote Storage menu  
You call the remote storage functionality under Remote Storage:  
Figure 38: AVR window - Remote Storage menu  
Remote Storage...  
Click Remote Storage... to open the Storage Devices window (see  
page 115). This window allows you to attach or detach media on the  
remote workstation as Remote Storage devices (see chapter "Remote  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
105  
 
Menus of the AVR window  
5.3.3 Power Control menu  
The Power Control menu allows you to power the server up/down or to reboot the  
server:  
Figure 39: AVR window - Power Control menu  
Power On  
Switches the server on.  
Power Off  
Powers the server down, regardless of the status of the operating  
system.  
Power Cycle  
Powers the server down completely and then powers it up again after a  
configured period. You can configure this time in the Power Cycle Delay  
field of the ASR&R Options group (see page 234).  
Press Power Button  
Depending on the operating system installed and the action configured,  
you can trigger various actions by briefly pressing the power-off button.  
These actions could be shutting down the computer or switching it to  
standby mode or sleep mode.  
Reset  
Completely restarts the server (cold start), regardless of the status of the  
operating system.  
106  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus of the AVR window  
Pulse NMI  
Initiates a non-maskable interrupt (NMI). A NMI is a processor interrupt  
that cannot be ignored by standard interrupt masking techniques in the  
system.  
Graceful Reboot  
Graceful shutdown and reboot.  
This option is only available if ServerView agents are installed and  
signed onto the iRMC S2/S3 as “Connected”.  
Graceful Shutdown  
Graceful shutdown and power off.  
This option is only available if ServerView agents are installed and  
signed onto the iRMC S2/S3 as “Connected”.  
5.3.4 Languages menu  
From the Languages menu, choose the language in which the menus and dialog  
boxes of the AVR window are to be shown:  
Figure 40: AVR window - Languages menu  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
107  
 
Menus of the AVR window  
5.3.5 Preferences menu  
The Preferences menu allows you to configure the mouse mode, keyboard layout,  
global logging, low bandwidth, and the internal TCP port:  
Figure 41: AVR window - Preferences menu  
I
If Video Redirection is executed in the Num Lock On mode on the server  
side, the client side also turns to Num Lock ON.  
Mouse Synch On Mode Change  
Default: Enabled.  
Specifies whether or not mouse pointer synchronization should be kept  
up after changing the Mouse Mode (see below).  
Mouse Mode  
Specifies the mouse mode (Hide Mode (Relative), Absolute Mode or  
Relative Mode).  
Depending on the server operating system, you must make the following  
settings:  
Windows: Absolute Mode, Hide Mode (Relative) or Relative Mode  
Linux: Hide Mode (Relative) or Relative Mode  
I
Default setting: Absolute Mode  
108  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus of the AVR window  
Keyboard Layout  
Specifies the keyboard layout for the virtual console.  
I
The keyboard layout at the managed server must also be set  
accordingly, i.e. the keyboard layout settings of AVR client and  
AVR server must be identical.  
Global Logging  
Default: No global logging.  
Specifies whether global logging is to be carried out.  
I
Global logging must be disabled, i.e. None must be set!  
Console Log File  
Specifies the log file for global logging.  
I
Depending on your selection under Global Logging, this option  
may be disabled.  
Low Bandwidth  
In the case of a reduced data transfer rate, you can configure here a  
lower bandwidth (bits per pixel, bpp) in terms of color depth for your all  
AVR sessions at the same iRMC S2/S3.  
None  
Default.  
No lower bandwidth.  
3 bpp  
3 bpp color depth (8 colors).  
8 bpp  
8 bpp color depth (256 colors).  
Internal TCP Port  
Default: 5901  
Specifies the internal TCP port for the integrated Remote Storage Client  
used at the AVR Client.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
109  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Remote Storage  
I
A valid license key is required to use the Remote Storage function.  
Remote Storage makes available to the managed server a “virtual” drive which  
is located elsewhere in the network. Up to two media can be redirected.  
You can provide the source for the virtual drive as follows:  
Via a remote storage connection as a physical drive or image file at the  
remote workstation using the AVR Java applet (see page 113) via a remote  
connection:  
Figure 42: Remote storage via a remote connection  
As a CD/DVD ISO image file centrally in the network via a Remote Storage  
server (see page 127):  
Figure 43: Remote storage via a Remote Storage Server  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
111  
   
I
Parallel remote storage connections:  
The following are possible concurrently:  
either up to two Remote Storage connections to virtual drives at the  
remote workstation (if the connection is established over the AVR  
Java applet)  
or  
one Remote Storage connection to a Remote Storage server.  
It is not possible to establish concurrent Remote Storage connections via  
I an applet and via the Remote Storage server.  
The Remote Storage page of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface allows you to  
obtain information on the status of the current remote storage  
connections and establish the connection to a Remote Storage server  
112  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
6.1  
Providing remote storage at the remote  
workstation  
If you provide the source for a virtual drive on the remote workstation then the  
remote storage functionality supports the following device types:  
Floppy  
CD ISO image  
DVD ISO image  
CD, DVD  
I
Optical storage media (CD, DVD) are automatically displayed (offered for  
selection). Other remote storage media must be made available as  
I remote storage by manually selecting the appropriate device type.  
Devices connected as remote storage are recognized as the USB  
connected devices by the iRMC S2/S3. They cannot be used if no USB  
connection is available (e.g. no USB driver exists).  
You can use the virtual drive to install an operating system on your PRIMERGY  
server from the remote workstation (see chapter "Remote installation of the  
This section provides information on the following topics:  
Starting Remote Storage  
Provision of storage media for Remote Storage  
Connecting storage media as remote storage  
Clearing Remote Storage connections  
Removing media made available for Remote Storage  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
113  
   
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
6.1.1 Starting Remote Storage  
You start the Remote Storage function using the AVR Java applet (see section  
Ê
Start the iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see section "Logging into the  
Ê
Open the Advanced Video Redirection page and click on the Start Video  
Redirection, button to start Advanced Video Redirection (see section  
This opens the AVR window.  
Ê
In the menu bar in the AVR window, choose:  
Remote Storage - Remote Storage...  
Figure 44: AVR window - Remote Storage - Remote Storage...  
The Storage Devices dialog box opens, containing the storage media currently  
available for Remote Storage.  
114  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
“Storage Devices” dialog box on a Windows system  
Figure 45: Storage Devices dialog box  
I
When a storage medium is inserted in an optical drive (CD ROM, DVD  
ROM) the contents are displayed automatically.  
Floppy disk drives and CD ROM / DVD ROM drives are not displayed in  
the list unless a medium is inserted.  
If a storage medium is inserted, but its contents are not displayed, the  
storage medium is reserved by the local explorer.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
115  
 
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
“Storage Devices” dialog box on a Linux system  
Figure 46: Storage Devices dialog box  
I
Physical storage media must be mounted to allow them to be connected  
as Remote Storage devices. Mounted storage media are automatically  
displayed in the Storage Devices dialog box.  
116  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
6.1.2 Provision of storage media for emote Storage  
Ê
In the Storage Devices dialog box, click Add... .  
The Add Storage Device dialog box opens.  
“Add Storage Device” dialog box on a Windows system  
Figure 47: Add Storage Device dialog box (Windows)  
“Add Storage Device” dialog box on a Linux system  
Figure 48: Add Storage Device dialog box (Linux)  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
117  
   
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
Ê
Ê
In the Add Storage Device dialog box, navigate to the directory of the remote  
storage medium that you want to make available for remote storage from  
your remote workstation.  
Select the required device type under Storage Type.  
The following storage types can be selected:  
Floppy  
CD ISO image  
DVD ISO image  
I
Physical storage devices must be mounted on Linux systems.  
Ê
Specify the storage medium you wish to connect as Remote Storage under  
File Name:  
In the case of an ISO image (ISO/NRG image), enter the file name.  
Alternatively, click on the file name in the Explorer.  
In the case of a drive, enter the name of the drive, e.g.  
“D” for drive D (Windows)  
/dev/... (Linux)  
“Add Storage Device” dialog: Selecting the storage medium (Windows)  
Figure 49: Add Storage Device dialog: Selecting the storage medium  
118  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
“Add Storage Device” dialog: Selecting the storage medium (Linux)  
Figure 50: Add Storage Device dialog: Selecting the storage medium  
Ê
Click Select to confirm your selection.  
The selected storage medium is made available for Remote Storage and  
displayed in the Storage Devices dialog.  
Display in the “Storage Devices” dialog (Windows)  
Figure 51: Storage Devices dialog: The provided storage medium is displayed.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
119  
 
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
Display in the “Storage Devices” dialog (Linux)  
Figure 52: Storage Devices dialog: The provided storage medium is displayed.  
120  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
6.1.3 Connecting storage media as remote storage  
Ê
In the Storage Devices dialog (see figure 51 and figure 52 on page 120), click  
the storage medium that you want to connect as Remote Storage.  
Ê
Click Connect to connect the selected storage medium as Remote Storage.  
The Storage Devices dialog opens with the message regarding safe removal.  
The storage medium is connected as Remote Storage.  
I
If you wish to connect two storage devices as Remote Storage at the  
same time, a confirmation dialog box is displayed before the  
connection is established (see section "Connecting two storage  
Storage Devices dialog: Showing Remote Storage connection (Windows)  
Figure 53: Storage Devices dialog: The storage medium is connected as Remote Storage.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
121  
   
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
Storage Devices dialog: Showing Remote Storage connection (Linux)  
Figure 54: Storage Devices dialog: The storage medium is connected as Remote Storage.  
122  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
Connecting two storage devices as Remote Storage at the same time  
I
The example in the following section illustrates how to simultaneously  
connect two storage media as Remote Storage on a Windows system.  
The same procedure applies for Linux systems.  
In figure 55, you can see that two storage devices have been provided as  
Remote Storage:  
Figure 55: Storage Devices dialog: Connecting 2 storage devices as Remote Storage  
Ê
Select the two storage devices and click Connect to connect the storage  
devices as Remote Storage.  
The system then makes a proposal regarding the assignment of your  
storage devices to USB 1.1 and USB 2.0 (see figure 55 on page 123).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
123  
   
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
Figure 56: Connection Type dialog: Assignment to USB 1.1 and USB 2.0  
Ê
Click Swap if you want to swap the assignment of the storage devices to  
USB 1.1 and USB 2.0.  
Figure 57: Connection Type dialog: Assignment to USB 1.1 and USB 2.0 swapped  
Ê
Click OK to connect the storage devices as Remote Storage.  
124  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
6.1.4 Clearing Remote Storage connections  
I
The Remote Storage connection is automatically released when the AVR  
session is disconnected.  
Ê
Open the Storage Devices dialog (see section "Starting Remote Storage" on  
The list of storage media connected as Remote Storage is displayed (using  
Windows in the example).  
Figure 58: Storage Devices dialog: Clearing Remote Storage connections  
Ê
Ê
“Safely remove” the storage device, i.e. ensure that no more  
applications/programs are accessing the storage media.  
Click Disconnect to clear all Remote Storage connections.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
125  
   
Providing remote storage at the remote workstation  
6.1.5 Removing the storage medium  
Remove a storage medium from the list of media available for Remote Storage  
as follows:  
Ê
Open the Storage Devices dialog (see section "Starting Remote Storage" on  
The list of storage media available for Remote Storage is displayed (using  
Windows in the example):  
Figure 59: Storage Devices dialog: Removing a Remote Storage medium  
Ê
Ê
Select the storage medium you want to remove.  
Click Remove... to remove the storage medium.  
126  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
6.2  
Providing remote storage via a Remote  
Storage server  
You can use a Remote Storage server to provide an image file (ISO/NRG  
image) as remote storage for any number of PRIMERGY servers that can be  
administered via iRMC S2/S3. You can use this image file to boot one or more  
PRIMERGY servers from the remote workstation (see chapter "Remote  
The Remote Storage server is available for Windows systems  
I
The Remote Storage server is available in a 32-bit and 64-bit variant for  
Windows. The 32-bit and 64-bit versions of the Remote Storage server  
I must not be installed at the same time on 64-bitsystems.  
You will find the individual variants of the Remote Storage server on your  
ServerView Suite DVD 1 under  
SVSoftware\Software\RemoteView\iRMC  
Making the ISO image available to the PRIMERGY Server via Remote  
Storage  
The following requirements must be satisfied if your PRIMERGY server is to use  
the image file made available by the Remote Storage server:  
The Remote Storage server must be installed (see page 128).  
The Remote Storage server must be started (see page 133).  
The managed server’s iRMC S2/S3 must be connected to the Remote  
Storage server (see page 312).  
Booting from WinPE 2.x-based ISO images  
A PRIMERGY server running iRMC S2/S3 and a firmware version Ï3.60A is  
required to boot from a WinPE 2.x-based ISO image (e.g. Windows Server 2008  
and ServerView Installation Manager).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
127  
   
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
6.2.1 Installing the Remote Storage server  
The Remote Storage server is available in 32-bit and 64-bit versions. The 32-bit  
and 64-bit versions of the Remote Storage server must not be installed at the  
same time on 64-bit systems.  
The installation programs RemoteStorageServer_Installer32.exe and  
RemoteStorageServer_Installer64.exe for installing the Remote Storage server are  
located on the ServerView Suite DVD 1 under  
SVSoftware\Software\RemoteView\iRMC\Widows_32 and  
SVSoftware\Software\RemoteView\iRMC\Widows_x64 respectively.  
Once installation has been completed successfully, your installation directory  
contains a number of files including RemoteStorageServer.exe.  
128  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
6.2.2 Remote Storage server execution modes  
You can execute the Remote Storage server in the following modes as required:  
as a background service  
as a stand-along program  
You configure the Remote Storage server execution mode via a graphical user  
interface (see page 130).  
Executing the Remote Storage server as a service  
The following points should be noted  
The image file can be located either on a computer in the network or on the  
same host on which the Remote Storage server is running.  
I
If the image file is not on the computer on which the Remote Storage  
server is running, you must specify the path of the image file in UNC  
notation. You also need a user account with access permissions on  
the image file.  
When the host on which the Remote Storage server is located is booted, the  
remote storage server starts automatically. The Remote Storage server is  
then executed until it is explicitly terminated or the host is shut down.  
When the host on which the Remote Storage server is located is booted, the  
image file becomes available automatically.  
Executing the Remote Storage server as a stand-alone program  
The following points should be noted  
The image file (ISO/NRG image) may be present locally on the Remote  
Storage server or on an assigned network drive.  
When the host on which the Remote Storage server is located is booted, you  
must start the image file “manually”.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
129  
   
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
6.2.3 Configuring, starting and exiting the Remote  
Storage server  
You configure, start and exit the Remote Storage server via a graphical user  
interface (GUI).  
Calling the Remote Storage server’s raphical user interface  
You call the Remote Storage server’s graphical user interface as follows:  
Ê
Choose Start - Programs - Fujitsu RemoteStorageServer - Remote Storage Server.  
The Remote Storage server’s graphical user interface appears:  
Figure 60: The Remote Storage server’s graphical user interface (here in the “Idle” state)  
130  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
Configuring the Remote Storage server  
I
Configuration is only possible if the Remote Storage server is in the “idle”  
state, i.e. it is not being executed.  
In the graphical user interface, you specify the image file made available as  
remote storage together with other parameters:  
ISO Image Path and Filename:  
Ê
Ê
Enter the path and name of the image file directly in the field.  
or:  
Click the Browse... button and then navigate to and select the required  
image file in the Choose a file dialog which now opens and then  
confirm.  
I
If the Remote Storage server is to run as a service (see the Run  
as Service option on page 132) and the image file is located on a  
computer in the network, you must specify the path of the image  
file in UNC notation. You must also ensure that the account  
entered under Log On As User (see page 132) is valid and has  
access permissions on the share on which the image file is  
located.  
Force Using Port  
If you have configured a port number other than the default port number  
(5901) for the iRMC S2/S3’s remote storage port (see page 248), then  
you must activate this option and enter the configured port number in the  
associated field.  
Force Using IP Address  
If the host on which the Remote Storage server is executed possesses  
more than one LAN connection:  
You can specify the IP address of the LAN connection that is to be used  
for the Remote Storage server if this is executed as a service.  
By default, the Remote Storage server uses the first detected LAN  
connection.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
131  
 
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
Run as Service  
Activate this option if the Remote Storage server is to be executed as a  
service in the background (see page 129).  
Ê
Select one of the two options below:  
Use Local System Account  
The Remote Storage server is executed as a service under the  
local system account.  
In this event, the image file (ISO/NRG image) must be located  
on a local drive.  
Log On As User  
he Remote Storage server is executed under the user account  
that you specify in the following input fields.  
Specify the user name in the form:  
For local users: .\Logon-Name  
For domain users:  
DOMAIN\LogOnName  
or  
LogOnName@DOMAIN<mailto:LogOnName@DOMAIN>  
I
The image file (ISO/NRG image) can be located on a network  
drive if the Log On As User option is enabled. In this event, the  
specified account must have access permissions on the  
network drive on which the image file is located. You must also  
specify the image file in UNC notation (see input field ISO  
Image Path or Filename on page 131).  
Ê
Click the Apply button to activate your settings.  
132  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
Starting the Remote Storage server  
Ê
Click the Start button to start the Remote Storage server as a service or as  
a stand-alone program:  
Figure 61: The Remote Storage server is executed (“Running” status)  
Status Messages:  
The logged execution states of the Remote Storage server are displayed  
I here.  
If the Run as service execution mode is configured (see page 132), then  
the Remote Storage server is started automatically when the computer  
I on which the Remote Storage server is installed is booted.  
Execution of the Remote Storage server is not interrupted automatically  
if the graphical user interface is exited.  
Exiting the Remote Storage server  
Ê
Click the Stop button to terminate execution of the Remote Storage server.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
133  
 
Providing remote storage via a Remote Storage server  
134  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
The iRMC S2/S3 not only has its own operating system, but also acts as a web  
server, providing its own interface. You can choose whether to show the menus  
and dialog boxes of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface in German, English or  
Japanese.  
When you enter values in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface, you often receive  
assistance in the form of tool tips.  
I
The software described below is based in part on the work of the  
Independent JPEG Group.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
135  
   
Logging into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
7.1  
Logging into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Ê
Open a web browser on the remote workstation and enter the (configured)  
DNS name (see page 249) or IP address of the iRMC S2/S3.  
Different login screens appear depending on whether LDAP access to a  
directory service has been configured for the iRMC S2/S3 (LDAP enabled  
option, see page 274):  
If no login screen appears, check the LAN connection (see section  
LDAP access to the directory service is not configured for the  
iRMC S2/S3 (LDAP enabled option is not activated) and Always use SSL  
Login option (see page 274) is not activated:  
Figure 62: Login screen for the iRMC S2/S3 web interface (LDAP access not  
configured and the “Always use SSL login” option is not selected)  
Ê
Type in the data for the default administrator account.  
User name: admin  
Password: admin  
I
Both the User name and the Password are case-sensitive.  
For reasons of security, it is recommended that you create a  
new administrator account once you have logged in, and then  
delete the default administrator account or at least change the  
password for the account (see "User “<name>” Configuration  
Ê
Click OK to confirm your entries.  
136  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Logging into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
LDAP access to the directory service is configured for the iRMC S2/S3  
(LDAP enabled option is activated) or Always use SSL Login option is  
activated):  
Figure 63: Login screen for the iRMC S2/S3 web interface (LDAP access configured)  
I
The user name and password are always SSL-protected when  
they are transmitted. If you activate the Secure (SSL) option, all  
communication between the web browser and the iRMC S2/S3 is  
carried out over HTTPS.  
Ê
Type in the data for the default administrator account.  
User name: admin  
Password: admin  
I
For reasons of security, it is recommended that you create a  
new administrator account once you have logged in, and then  
delete the default administrator account or at least change the  
password for the account (see "User “<name>” Configuration  
Ê
Click Login to confirm your entries.  
The iRMC S2/S3 web interface opens showing the System Information page (see  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
137  
 
Required user permissions  
7.2  
Required user permissions  
table 4 provides an overview of the permissions which are required in order to  
use the individual functions available at the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
Functions in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Permitted with  
IPMI privilege  
level  
Required  
iRMC S2/S3-  
specific  
permission  
Open the System Overview page.  
Switch identification LED on/off.  
Set Asset Tag Configuration.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1)  
Edit Operating System Informations  
Open the System Component Information page.  
Reset Memory Error Counter.  
X
X
X
X
X
View SPD Data.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Open the Backup/Restoration of BIOS Single Parameter  
2)  
Settings page.  
2)  
Edit Backup/Restoration of BIOS Single Param. Settings  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
2)  
Open the BIOS Update Settings page.  
X
X
X
X
2)  
Perform BIOS update  
X
Open the iRMC S2/S3 Information page.  
Reboot iRMC S2/S3.  
Load license key onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Set Miscellaneous Options  
X
X
Open the Save iRMC S2/S3 FW Settings page.  
X
X
Table 4: Permissions to use special the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
138  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Required user permissions  
Functions in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Permitted with  
IPMI privilege  
level  
Required  
iRMC S2/S3-  
specific  
permission  
Select Include User Settings.  
X
Select any other setting option(s).  
X
Import iRMC S2/S3 settings in WinSCU XML format from  
file.  
X
X
Open/edit the Certificate Upload page.  
Open/edit the Generate a self-signed RSA Cert. page  
Open iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update page.  
Set firmware selector.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Perform Firmware Update from File.  
Update firmware via TFTP (iRMC S2/S3 TFTP Settings).  
Open Power On/Off page.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Modify Boot Options.  
X
X
Use Power Control.  
Open/edit the Power Options page.  
Open Power Supply Info page.  
Open/edit Power Consumption Configuration page  
X
X
X
2)  
Open Current Power Consumption page  
2)  
Open/edit Power Consumption History page .  
Open Fans page.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Start fan test (Fan Test group).  
Set Fan Check Time (Fan Test group).  
X
Table 4: Permissions to use special the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
iRMC S2/S3  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Required user permissions  
Functions in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Permitted with  
IPMI privilege  
level  
Required  
iRMC S2/S3-  
specific  
permission  
Select individual Fans (System Fans group).  
Set Fan Fail Action / Delay Time.  
X
X
Open Temperature page  
X
X
X
X
Define action on critical temperature.  
Open Voltages page.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Open Power Supply page.  
Configure power supply redundancy  
Open Component Status page.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Open System Event Log Content page.  
Clear the system event log (SEL).  
Save event log (SEL).  
X
X
Define the severity for the display of SEL entries  
Open Internal Event Log Content page.  
Clear the internal event log (iEL).  
Save event log (iEL)  
Define the severity for the display of SEL entries  
Open Event Log Configuration page.  
Edit System Event Log Configuration settings.  
Edit Internal Event Log Configuration settings.  
Open/edit Server Management Info. page.  
Open/edit the Network Interface page.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Table 4: Permissions to use special the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
140  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Required user permissions  
Functions in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Permitted with  
IPMI privilege  
level  
Required  
iRMC S2/S3-  
specific  
permission  
Open/edit the Ports and Netw. Services page.  
Open/edit DNS Configuration page.  
Open/edit SNMP TRAP Alerting page.  
Open/edit Serial / Modem Alerting page.  
Open/edit the Email Alerting page.  
Open/edit the iRMC S2/S3 User page.  
Open/edit the Directory Service Config. page.  
Open CAS Configuration page  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Edit CAS Generic Configuration  
Edit CAS User Privilege and Permissions  
Open the BIOS Text Console page.  
Modify the BIOS Console Redirection Options.  
Start Console Redirection.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Logon in window for power mgmt & text console red.  
Start the text console (Enter Console).  
Open/edit the Advanced Video Redirection page.  
Open/edit the Remote Storage page.  
Start iRMC S2/S3 SSH Access.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
SSH login  
Start iRMC S2/S3 Telnet Access.  
Telnet login  
Table 4: Permissions to use special the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
iRMC S2/S3  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Required user permissions  
Functions in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
Permitted with  
IPMI privilege  
level  
Required  
iRMC S2/S3-  
specific  
permission  
1)  
Action is only possible if no agents are running.  
2)  
Feature is not available on all systems.  
Table 4: Permissions to use special the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
142  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Structure of the user interface  
7.3  
Structure of the user interface  
The iRMC S2/S3 web interface is structured as follows:  
Selected function  
Interface language selector  
Title bar  
Logout button  
Navigation area  
Working area  
Figure 64: Structure of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
143  
   
Structure of the user interface  
Choosing the language for the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
On the right of the black bar above the work area, you will find a flag icon. Click  
this icon to choose the language (German / English / Japanese) used to display  
the navigation area, menus and dialog boxes of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
Navigation area  
The navigation area contains the menu tree structure whose nodes combine the  
links to the individual iRMC S2/S3 functions arranged on a task basis. When you  
click one of these links (in figure 64: System Overview), the link is enabled and the  
work area for that function is displayed showing any output, dialog boxes,  
options, links and buttons.  
Below the links to the individual iRMC S2/S3 functions, you will find the links  
Logout and Refresh:  
Logout allows you to terminate the iRMC S2/S3 session after you have  
confirmed this in a dialog box. Different login screens appear after the  
session has been closed depending on whether LDAP access to a directory  
service has been configured for the iRMC S2/S3 (LDAP enabled option, see  
If LDAP access to the directory service is not configured for the  
iRMC S2/S3 (LDAP enabled is not activated) and then Always use SSL login  
option (see page 274) is deactivated, the following login screen appears:  
Figure 65: Login page (after logging out)  
144  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Structure of the user interface  
Click Login to open the login screen of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
(see figure 62 on page 136). This allows you to log in again if you wish.  
If LDAP access to the directory service is configured for the iRMC S2/S3  
(LDAP enabled option is activated) or the Always use SSL login option (see  
page 274) is deactivated, the appropriate login screen appears (see  
Click Refresh to refresh the contents of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
I
Alternatively, you can configure the interface to automatically update  
the contents periodically (see "Enable Auto Refresh" on page 246).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
145  
System Information - Information on the server  
7.4  
System Information -  
Information on the server  
The System Information entry contains the links to the following pages:  
146  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Information - Information on the server  
7.4.1 System Overview -  
General information on the server  
The System Overview page provides information on  
the system status,  
system (general information)  
the operating system of the managed server,  
system FRUs (Field Replaceable Units) / IDPROM.  
current overall power consumption of the managed server  
In addition, the System Overview page allows you to enter a customer-specific  
asset tag for the managed server.  
Figure 66: System Overview page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
147  
 
System Information - Information on the server  
System Status  
The status of the global error LED, the CSS LED and the identification LED are  
shown under System Status. You can also switch the PRIMERGY identification  
LED on and off.  
Figure 67: System Overview page - System Status  
Power LED  
Power status of the server.  
The following statuses are possible:  
On: “Power ON” (green)  
On: “Standby mode (green) with text “Suspend to RAM (Standby)”.  
Off: “Power OFF” (orange)  
Error LED  
Informs about the server‘s Global Error LED:  
Status Info  
Global Error LED  
Status of the servers  
(iRMC S2/S3) on the Server  
off  
does not light up.  
lights red.  
No critical event.  
on  
Prefailure event for a non CSS component.  
Critical event.  
blinking  
flashes red.  
CSS LED  
Informs about the server’s CSS (Customer Self Service) LED:  
Status Info  
CSS LED on the  
Status of the server  
(iRMC S2/S3) Server  
off  
does not light up.  
The server is operational.  
on  
lights orange.  
Prefailure event for a CSS component.  
Defective CSS component.  
blinking  
flashes orange.  
148  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Information - Information on the server  
Identify LED  
Server identifier.  
The following statuses are possible:  
On (blue)  
Off (grey)  
Turn On/Turn Off  
Click Turn On / Turn Off to toggle the PRIMERGY identification  
LED on and off.  
Asset Tag Configuration  
Under Asset Tag Configuration, you can enter a customer-specific asset tag for  
the managed server.  
I
The customer-specific asset tag allows you to assign the server an  
inventory number or other identifier of your choice.  
With Windows-based systems, this customer-specific asset tag is  
provided automatically by the WMI (Windows Management  
Instrumentation). It can then be evaluated by in-house tools or used for  
integration in enterprise management systems (such as CA Unicenter).  
Figure 68: The System Overview - System Status page  
System Asset Tag  
You can enter the asset tag here.  
Ê
Click Apply to accept the asset tag.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
149  
System Information - Information on the server  
System Information  
System Information lists information on the managed server.  
Figure 69: System Overview page - System Information  
Operating System Information  
Operating System Information lists information on the operating system of the  
managed server.  
Figure 70: System Overview page - Operating System Information  
I
If no ServerView agents are running, you can edit the System Location and  
System contact fields, otherwise these fields are not editable.  
After the ServerView agents have been started, your initial values will be  
overwritten by the values automatically detected by the agents.  
150  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Information - Information on the server  
System FRU / IDPROM Information  
Information on the FRUs (Field Replaceable Units) is listed under  
System FRU/IDPROM Information. FRUs are system components that can be  
released and removed from the system. The CSS Component column indicates  
for each of the components whether the CSS (Customer Self Service)  
functionality is supported.  
Figure 71: System Overview page - System FRU / IDPROM Information  
Current Overall Power Consumption  
I
This option is not supported for all PRIMERGY servers.  
Figure 72: System Overview page - Current Overall Power Consumption  
Under Current Overall Power Consumption you can see all the measurements  
current, minimum, maximum and average power consumption for the server in  
the current interval.  
A graphical display also shows the current power consumption of the server  
compared with the maximum possible power consumption.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
151  
System Information - Information on the server  
7.4.2 System Component Information -  
Information on the server components  
The System Component Information page provides information on the CPU and  
the main memory modules. The CSS Component column indicates for each of the  
components whether the CSS (Customer Self Service) functionality is  
supported.  
The following status icons indicate the possible statuses of the system  
components:  
OK: Component status is okay.  
Component slot is empty.  
Warning: The status of the component has deteriorated.  
Fault: The component has a fault.  
Table 5: Status of the system component  
152  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Information - Information on the server  
Figure 73: System Component Information page  
I
On PRIMERGY servers with support for TPM (Trusted Platform Module),  
this page indicates whether TPM is enabled or disabled.  
System CPU Information  
This group provides information on the status, IDs, CSS capability and  
performance of the CPU(s) in the managed PRIMERGY server.  
iRMC S2/S3  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Information - Information on the server  
System Memory Information  
This group provides information on the status, IDs, CSS capability and  
performance of the main memory modules in the managed PRIMERGY server.  
Select  
Here you can select individual memory modules to which the action you  
select under Please select memory action from list is to be applied.  
Select all  
Selects all memory modules.  
Deselect all  
Cancels your selection.  
Please select memory action from list  
This list allows you to select an action to be applied to the selected  
memory modules.  
Apply to the selected modules  
Applies the selected action to the selected memory modules.  
View SPD Data / No SPD Data  
Clicking the toggle button View SPD Data / No SPD Data shows or hides  
vendor-specific details (Serial Presence Detect (SPD) data) for the  
individual memory components.  
The SPD data for a memory component is stored in an EEPROM  
integrated in the component and serves to allow the BIOS to  
automatically detect this memory component (RAM, DIMM).  
154  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
7.5  
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings,  
flashing BIOS  
The BIOS entry contains the links to the following pages:  
I
These pages are only displayed if the BIOS of the managed server  
supports the corresponding feature requirements.  
7.5.1 Backup/Restoration - Saving/Restoring BIOS  
single parameter settings to/from a file  
The Backup/Restoration of BIOS Single Parameter Settings page provides you with  
the following options:  
Back up single BIOS parameters in ServerView® WinSCU XML format and  
save the backup to a file.  
Restore single BIOS parameter settings in ServerView® WinSCU XML  
format from a file.  
Figure 74: Backup/Restoration of BIOS Single Parameter Settings page  
iRMC S2/S3  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
7.5.1.1 Backing up single BIOS parameters in ServerView® WinSCU  
XML format  
The Backup BIOS Single Parameters in ServerView® WinSCU XML format group  
allows you to back up single BIOS parameter settings in ServerView® WinSCU  
XML format and to save the backup to a file.  
Figure 75: Backup BIOS Single Parameters in ServerView® WinSCU XML format  
Backup Status  
Displays the status of the current backup process. Successful completion  
is indicated by "Operation Successful". The Backup Status is only  
displayed if a backup is currently in process or has completed.  
You can clear the status display by clicking the Clear Status button, which  
is only available if a status is currently displayed.  
Clear Status  
Clears the status information indicated under Backup Status. This button  
is only available if a status is currently displayed under Backup Status.  
Backup Filename  
This input field is disabled ("grayed out") by default. Initially, it displays the  
file name that is dynamically generated by the iRMC S2/S3.  
Edit Filename  
Enables the Backup Filename field, thus allowing you to enter a file  
name (.pre) of your choice.  
Save Filename  
Saves the edited file name, which, starting from now, will be the  
name displayed by default in the Backup Filename field.  
156  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
Request BIOS Parameter Backup  
Initiates a backup of single BIOS parameter settings in ServerView®  
WinSCU XML format. The backup (with the name specified in the  
Backup Filename field) is stored locally on the iRMC S2/S3.  
Once the backup process has started, the current process status is  
displayed under Backup Status.  
I
Notes on the backup process:  
During the backup process, all buttons and input fields are  
disabled.  
If powered off, the managed server will be automatically  
powered on.  
If the server is powered on, a reboot is required. Otherwise, the  
backup process will remain in state "Boot Pending".  
The managed server is powered off after the backup has  
completed.  
Save Backup to File  
Opens a browser dialog allowing you to save the iRMC S2/S3-local copy  
of the BIOS backup data to a file (<name -of-your-choice>.pre).  
This button is only displayed when a backup of single BIOS parameters  
in ServerView® WinSCU XML format is available in the local store of the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
7.5.1.2 Restoring single BIOS parameters in ServerView® WinSCU XML  
format  
The Restoration BIOS Single Parameters in ServerView® WinSCU XML format group  
allows you to restore single BIOS parameter settings from a restoration file in  
ServerView® WinSCU XML format.  
Figure 76: Restoration BIOS Single Parameters in ServerView® WinSCU XML format  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
157  
 
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
Restoration Status  
Displays the status of the current restoration process. Successful  
completion is indicated by "Operation successful". The Restoration Status  
is only displayed if a restoration is currently in process or has completed.  
You can clear the status display by clicking the Clear Status button, which  
is only available if a status is currently displayed.  
Clear Status  
Clears the status information indicated under Restoration Status. This  
button is only displayed if a status is currently indicated under  
Restoration Status.  
Restoration File  
Clicking the input field or clicking Browse... opens a browser dialog  
allowing you to navigate to a file (.pre) containing a backup of single BIOS  
parameters in the ServerView® WinSCU XML format.  
Apply  
Initiates the restoration of single BIOS parameter settings based on the  
file specified in the Restoration File field.  
Once the restoration process has started, the current process status is  
indicated under Restoration Status.  
I
Notes on the restoration process:  
During the restoration process, all buttons and input fields are  
disabled.  
If powered off, the managed server will automatically be  
powered on.  
If the managed server is powered on, the server is to be  
rebooted. Otherwise the restoration process will remain in  
state "Boot Pending".  
The managed server is powered off after the restoration has  
completed.  
158  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
7.5.2 BIOS - Updating BIOS via "upload from file" or via  
TFTP  
The BIOS Update Settings page provides information on the current BIOS version  
on the managed server and allows you to update the BIOS via "upload from file"  
or via TFTP.  
I
You will find the appropriate BIOS image for your PRIMERGY server on  
ServerView Suite DVD 1 or you can download it under  
http://support.ts.fujitsu.com/com/support/downloads.html.  
Figure 77: BIOS Update Settings page  
iRMC S2/S3  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
Updating (flashing) the BIOS - course of events and important notes  
The following overview applies for both updating the BIOS via "upload from file"  
and updating the BIOS via TFTP.  
I
Details on how to initiate the steps described in this overview are  
I described below in this section.  
During the complete update process, the current update status is  
indicated in the BIOS Update Settings page.  
Figure 78: Updating BIOS - (TFTP) download successfully finished  
Updating the BIOS comprises the following steps:  
1. In the first step, you download the update file.  
I
The update file must be a UPC file.  
After the update file has been downloaded, the following occurs:  
If the server is powered off, the server will be automatically powered on  
to initiate the flash process.  
If the server is already powered on, you must restart the server to initiate  
the flash process.  
V
CAUTION!  
If a BIOS update is currently in progress, do not power-off or restart  
the server.  
160  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
2. Subsequently, flash data is transferred to memory. The status display will  
indicate when the transfer has successfully completed.  
3. Before the actual flashing process is started, the flash/update image is  
checked.  
Figure 79: Updating BIOS - checking update/flash image  
4. Once the update/flash image is successfully verified, the actual flashing  
process is started. The status indication shows the percentage completion  
of the flash process.  
5. After the BIOS update has successfully completed, the server is powered  
off. The following entry is written to the system event log (SEL):  
BIOS TFTP or HTTP/HTTPS flash OK  
BIOS Information  
This group provides information on the current BIOS version on the managed  
server.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
161  
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
BIOS Upload from File  
The BIOS Upload from File group allows you to perform an online update of the  
BIOS on the managed server. To do this, you must provide the current BIOS  
image in a file.  
Figure 80: BIOS Update Settings page - BIOS Update from File  
Update file  
File in which the BIOS image is stored.  
I
A UPC-format file is required for performing the BIOS Upload from  
File function.  
Browse...  
Opens a file browser that allows you to navigate to the update file.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings and to start flashing the BIOS.  
V
CAUTION!  
If a BIOS update is currently in progress, do not power-off or restart  
the server.  
162  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS - Backing up/restore BIOS settings, flashing BIOS  
BIOS TFTP Update Settings  
The BIOS TFTP Update Settings group allows you to perform an online update of  
the BIOS on the managed server. To do this, you must provide the current BIOS  
image in a file on a TFTP server. The BIOS is flashed when TFTP is started.  
Figure 81: BIOS Update Settings page - BIOS TFTP Update Settings  
TFTP Server  
IP address or DNS name of the TFTP server on which the file with the  
BIOS image is stored.  
Update file  
File in which the BIOS image is stored.  
I
A UPC-format file is required for performing the BIOS TFTP Update  
Settings function.  
Ê
Ê
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Click TFTP Test to test the connection to the TFTP server.  
Click TFTP Start to download the file containing the BIOS image from the  
TFTP server and to start flashing the BIOS.  
V
CAUTION!  
If a BIOS update is currently in progress, do not power-off or restart  
the server.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
163  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
7.6  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and  
certificates  
The iRMC S2/S3 entry contains the links to the following pages:  
164  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
7.6.1 iRMC S2/S3 Information -  
Information on the iRMC S2/S3  
The iRMC S2/S3 Information page provides you with the following options:  
View information on the firmware and the SDRR version of the iRMC S2/S3,  
set the firmware selector and load a firmware image and restart the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
View information on the active iRMC S2/S3 sessions.  
Load license key onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Make settings for the layout of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
Figure 82: iRMC S2/S3 Information page  
iRMC S2/S3  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Running Firmware  
Under Running Firmware, you can view information on the firmware and the  
SDRR version of the iRMC S2/S3 and restart the iRMC S2/S3.  
Figure 83: iRMC S2/S3 Information page - Firmware Information and iRMC S2/S3 reboot  
Reboot iRMC S2/S3  
Reboots the iRMC S2/S3.  
I
The Reboot iRMC S2/S3 button is disabled during the BIOS POST  
phase of the managed server.  
Active Session Information  
The Active Session Information group shows all the currently active iRMC S2/S3  
sessions.  
Figure 84: iRMC S2/S3 Information page - Active Session Information  
166  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
License Key  
The License Key group allows you to load a license key onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Figure 85: iRMC S2/S3 Information page - License Key  
I
You require a valid license key to be able to use the iRMC S2/S3  
functions Advanced Video Redirection (see page 302) and Remote Storage  
You can purchase the license key.  
Upload  
When you click this button, the license key specified in the input field is  
loaded onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Miscellaneous iRMC S2/S3 Options  
The Miscellaneous iRMC S2/S3 Options group allows you to make settings for the  
layout of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
Figure 86: iRMC Information page - Miscellaneous Options  
Default Language  
Specifies the language (German / English / Japanese) that is set as  
default the next time the iRMC S2/S3 web interface is called.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
167  
   
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Temperature Units  
Specifies the unit used for displaying temperature values at the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface (degrees Celsius / degrees Fahrenheit). This  
setting applies for the current session and is preset the next time the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface is called.  
Colour Schema  
Specifies the color scheme for displaying the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
This setting applies for the current session and is preset the next time the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface is called.  
Show Video Redirection in Navigation  
Adds the Video Redirction link to the navigation area. This link allows you  
to directly start video redirection (see "Video Redirection - Starting AVR"  
Show Video Redirection (Java Web Start) in Navigation  
Adds the Video Redirction (JWS) link to the navigation area. This allows  
you to directly start video redirection (Java Web Start) (see "Video  
Show the Text Console (SOL) in Navigation  
Adds the Text Console (SOL) link to the navigation area. This allows you to  
directly start text console redirection (see section "Text Console  
Show the ’Logout’ in Navigation  
This option is only available if the iRMC S2/S3 information page is  
displayed in the StyleguideVersion 2.2 color scheme.  
Adds the Logout link to the navigation area. This allows you to logout via  
the navigation area.  
168  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
7.6.2 Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Settings -  
Save firmware settings  
The Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Settings page allows you to save the current  
firmware settings and a number of other settings for the iRMC S2/S3 in a file.  
Additionally, you can load the firmware settings onto the iRMC S2/S3 again.  
The firmware settings selected under Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware settings in  
ServerView® WinSCU XML format are saved in a file with the name  
iRMC_S2_settings.pre or iRMC_ S3_settings.pre, respectively. In the Server  
Configuration Manager (WinSCU), you can use the Import... button to load  
the firmware settings onto the iRMC S2/S3 again.  
The firmware settings selected under Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware settings in  
binary (BMCCLONE.exe) format are saved in a file with the name  
iRMC_S2_settings.bin or iRMC_ S3_settings.bin, respectively. You can use  
the Import iRMC S2/S3 Firmware settings in ServerView® WinSCU XML format  
from file group to load the firmware settings onto the iRMC S2/S3 again.  
V
CAUTION!  
Always save the setting using  
Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware settings in ServerView® WinSCU XML format.  
Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware settings in binary (BMCCLONE.exe) format  
should only be used if the system module of the managed server is being  
I replaced.  
If you want to save the user settings (Include User Settings), you require  
Configure User Accounts permission. In all other cases, Configure  
iRMC S2/S3 settings permission is sufficient.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
169  
   
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Figure 87: Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Settings page  
Save iRMC S2/S3 firmware settings ...  
The data is exported from the iRMC S2/S3 in logical sections, each  
corresponding to a selected option.  
The option All other Firmware settings causes the firmware to export all current  
ConfigSpace values that have not already been exported together with another  
section. New implemented values are automatically exported with newer  
firmware versions.  
Save  
Click Save to save the selected settings.  
Save All  
Click Save All to save all the settings.  
170  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Import iRMC S2/S3 Firmware settings in ServerView® WinSCU XML  
format from file  
Config File  
Configuration file (default: iRMC_S2_settings.bin / iRMC_S3_settings.bin) in  
the ServerView® WinSCU XML format from which you want to load the  
firmware settings onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Browse  
Opens a file browser that allows you to navigate to the configuration file.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
171  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
7.6.3 Certificate Upload - Load the DSA/RSA certificate  
and private DSA/RSA key  
The Certificate Upload page allows you to load a signed X.509 DSA/RSA  
certificate (SSL) from a Certificate Authority (CA) and/or your private DSA/RSA  
key (SSH) onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
I
The iRMC S2/S3 is supplied with a predefined server certificate (default  
certificate). If you want to access the iRMC S2/S3 over secure SSL/SSH  
connections, it is recommended that you replace the certificate with one  
I signed by a Certificate Authority (CA) as soon as possible.  
Input format of the X.509 DSA/RSA certificate and the private DSA/RSA  
key:  
The X.509 DSA/RSA certificate and the RSA/DSA must both be  
available in PEM-encoded format (ASCII/Base64).  
172  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Figure 88: Certificate Upload page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
173  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Displaying the currently valid (CA) DSA/RSA certificate  
Ê
In the group Certificate Information and Restore, click View Certificate to show  
the currently valid SSH/SSL-certificate.  
Ê
In the group Certificate Information and Restore, click View CA Certificate to  
show the currently valid CA certificate.  
Figure 89: Certificate Upload page - display of the currently valid SSL/SSH certificate  
174  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Restoring the default certificate default CA certificate  
Ê
In the group Certificate Information and Restore, click Default Certificate to  
restore the default certificate delivered with the firmware after you have  
confirmed that you wish to do so.  
Ê
In the group Certificate Information and Restore, click Default CA Certificate to  
restore the default CA certificate delivered with the firmware after you have  
confirmed that you wish to do so.  
Figure 90: Certificate Upload page - Restoring the default CA certificate  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
175  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Loading a CA certificate from a local file  
Use the CA Certificate upload from file group to load a CA certificate from a local  
file.  
Figure 91: Loading a CA certificate from a local file  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Ê
Save the CA certificate in a local file on the managed server.  
Specify this file under CA Certificate File by clicking the associated Browse...  
button and navigating to the file containing the CA certificate.  
Ê
Click Upload to load the certificate and/or the private key onto the iRMC  
S2/S3.  
I
When you upload the certificate and/or private key, all the existing  
HTTPS connections are closed and the HTTPS server is  
automatically restarted. This process can take up to 30 seconds.  
No explicit reset of the iRMC S2/S3 is required.  
Ê
Click View CA Certificate to make sure that the certificate has been loaded  
successfully.  
176  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Loading the DSA/RSA certificate and private DSA/RSA key from local files  
You do this using the group  
SSL Certificate and DSA/RSA private key upload from file.  
I
The private key and the certificate must be loaded on the iRMC S2/S3 at  
the same time.  
Figure 92: Loading the DSA/RSA certificate/private DSA/RSA key from local files  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Save the X.509 DSA/RSA (SSL) certificate and the private DSA/RSA key in  
corresponding local files on the managed server.  
Ê
Specify the files Private Key File and Certificate File by clicking on the  
associated Browse button and navigating to the file which contains the  
private key or the certificate.  
Ê
Ê
Click Upload to load the certificate and the private key onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
I
When you upload the certificate and private key, all the existing  
HTTPS connections are closed and the HTTPS server is  
automatically restarted. This process can take up to 30 seconds.  
No explicit reset of the iRMC S2/S3 is required.  
Click View Certificate to make sure that the certificate has been loaded  
successfully.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
177  
 
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Entering the DSA/RSA certificate/private DSARSA key directly  
You do this using the group SSL DSA/RSA certificate or DSA/RSA private upload via  
copy & paste.  
I
Do not use this method to load a root certificate onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Always load a root certificate using a file (see page 177).  
Figure 93: Entering the DSA/RSA certificate/private DSARSA key directly  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Copy the X.509 DSA certificate or the private DSA key to the input area.  
I
You cannot simultaneously enter the certificate and key for the same  
upload.  
Ê
Ê
Click Upload to load the certificate or the private key onto the iRMC S2/S3.  
Use the Remote Manager to reset the iRMC S2/S3 (see section "Service  
I
This is necessary in order to make a certificate or private key loaded  
onto the iRMC S2/S3 valid.  
Ê
Click View Certificate to make sure that the certificate has been loaded  
successfully.  
178  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
7.6.4 Generate a self-signed Certificate -  
Generate self-signed RSA certificate  
You can create a self-signed certificate using the Generate a self-signed Certificate  
page.  
Figure 94: Generate a self-signed RSA Certificate page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
179  
 
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Certificate Information and Restore  
The Certificate Information and Restore group allows you to view the currently  
valid DSA/RSA certificate and/or restore the default RSA/DSA certificate.  
View Certificate  
You can view the currently valid DSA/RSA certificate using this button.  
Default Certificate  
You can use this button to restore the default certificate delivered with the  
firmware after you have confirmed that you wish to do so.  
Certificate Creation  
Proceed as follows to create a self-signed certificate:  
Ê
Ê
Enter the requisite details under Certificate Creation.  
Click Create to create the certificate.  
I
When generating the new certificate, all the existing HTTPS  
connections are closed and the HTTPS server is automatically  
restarted. This can take up to 5 minutes depending on the key length.  
No explicit reset of the iRMC S2/S3 is required.  
180  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
7.6.5 iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update  
The iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update page allows you to update the iRMC S2/S3  
firmware online. To do this, you must provide the current firmware image either  
locally on a remote workstation or on a TFTP server.  
Here you can also see information on the iRMC S2/S3 firmware and set the  
firmware selector.  
Figure 95: iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
181  
   
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Firmware Image Information  
Under Firmware Image Information, you can view information on the firmware  
version and the SDRR version of the iRMC S2/S3 and set the firmware selector.  
Figure 96: iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update - Firmware Information  
Firmware Selector  
You use the firmware selector to specify which firmware image is to be  
activated the next time the iRMC S2/S3 is rebooted.  
You have the following options:  
Auto - FW Image with highest FW version  
The firmware image with the most recent version is selected  
automatically.  
Low FW Image  
The low firmware image is selected.  
High FW Image  
The high firmware image is selected.  
Select FW Image with oldest FW version  
The firmware image with the oldest version is selected.  
Select most recently programmed FW  
The most recently updated firmware image is selected.  
Select least recently programmed FW  
The least recently updated firmware image is selected.  
Apply  
Click Apply to set the firmware selector to the option you have set under  
Firmware Selector.  
182  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Firmware Update from File  
The Firmware Update from File group allows you to update the iRMC S2/S3  
firmware online. To do this, you must provide the current firmware image in a file  
on a remote workstation.  
You will find the appropriate firmware image for your PRIMERGY server on  
ServerView Suite DVD 1 or you can download it under  
http://support.ts.fujitsu.com/com/support/downloads.html.  
Figure 97: iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update page - Firmware Update from File  
Flash Selector  
Specify what iRMC firmware is to be updated.  
You have the following options:  
Auto - inactive firmware  
The inactive firmware is automatically selected.  
Low Firmware Image  
The low firmware image (firmware image 1) is selected.  
High Firmware Image  
The high firmware image (firmware image 2) is selected.  
iRMC S2/S3  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Update file  
File in which the firmware image is stored.  
I
The files listed below each allow you to update one component of  
the iRMC S2/S3 firmware in every update run (runtime firmware  
and SDR record).  
The file rt_sdr_<D-number>_4_08g_00.bin is also available for  
some PRIMERGY servers / blade servers. This allows you to  
update all the components of the iRMC S2/S3 firmware in a single  
operation.  
dcod<FW-Version>.bin  
Updates the runtime firmware.  
<SDR-Version>.SDR  
Updates the SDR record.  
Browse...  
Opens a file browser that allows you to navigate to the update file.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings and to start updating the iRMC S2/S3  
firmware.  
iRMC S2/S3 TFTP Settings  
The iRMC S2/S3 TFTP Settings group allows you to update the iRMC S2/S3  
firmware online. To do this, you must provide the current firmware image in a file  
on a TFTP server.  
You will find the appropriate firmware image for your PRIMERGY server on  
ServerView Suite DVD 1 or you can download it under  
http://support.ts.fujitsu.com/com/support/downloads.html.  
Figure 98: iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update page - iRMC S2/S3 TFTP Settings  
TFTP Server  
IP address or DNS name of the TFTP server on which the file with the  
firmware image is stored.  
184  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iRMC S2/S3 - Information, firmware and certificates  
Update file  
File in which the firmware image is stored.  
I
The files listed below each allow you to update one component of  
the iRMC S2/S3 firmware every time TFTP is started (runtime  
firmware and SDR record).  
The file rt_sdr_<D-number>_4_08g_00.bin is also available for  
some PRIMERGY servers / blade servers. This allows you to  
update all the components of the iRMC S2/S3 firmware in a single  
operation using a TFTP server.  
dcod<FW-Version>.bin  
Updates the runtime firmware.  
<SDR-Version>.SDR  
Updates the SDR record.  
Flash Selector  
Specify what iRMC firmware is to be updated.  
You have the following options:  
Auto - inactive firmware  
The inactive firmware is automatically selected.  
Low Firmware Image  
The low firmware image (firmware image 1) is selected.  
High Firmware Image  
The high firmware image (firmware image 2) is selected.  
Ê
Ê
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Click TFTP Test to test the connection to the TFTP server.  
Click TFTP Start to download the file containing the firmware image from the  
TFTP server and to start updating the iRMC S2/S3 firmware.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
185  
Power Management  
7.7  
Power Management  
The Power Management entry contains the links to the power management pages  
for your PRIMERGY server:  
186  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Management  
7.7.1 Power On/Off - power the server up/down  
The Power On/Off page allows you to power the managed server on and off. You  
are informed of the server’s current power status and are also able to configure  
the behavior of the server during the next boot operation.  
Figure 99: Power On/Off page  
Power Status Summary  
The Power Status Summary group provides information on the current power  
status of the server and on the causes for the most recent Power On/Power Off.  
In addition, a Power On counter records the total months, days and minutes  
during which the server has been powered.  
Figure 100: Power On/Off page - Power Status Summary  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
187  
 
Power Management  
Boot Options  
The Boot Options group allows you to configure the behavior of the system the  
next time it is booted. You can set whether the BIOS is to interrupt the boot  
process for the system if errors occur during the POST phase.  
I
The options set here only apply to the next boot operation. After this, the  
default mechanism applies again.  
Figure 101: Power Management - Boot Options page  
Ê
Select the desired BIOS behavior from the Error Halt Settings list:  
Continue  
Continue the boot process if errors occur during the POST phase.  
Halt on errors  
Interrupt the boot process if errors occur during the POST phase.  
Ê
From the Boot Device Selector list, select the storage medium you wish to boot  
from.  
The following options are available:  
No change: The system is booted from the same storage medium as  
previously.  
PXE/iSCSI: The system is booted from PXE/iSCSI over the network.  
Harddrive: The system is booted from hard disk.  
CDROM/DVD: The system is booted from CD /DVD.  
Floppy: The system is booted from floppy disk.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
188  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Management  
Power Control - powering the server up and down/rebooting the server  
The Power Control group allows you to power the server up/down or to reboot  
the server.  
Figure 102: Power On/Off page, Restart (server is powered up)  
Figure 103: Power On/Off page, Restart (server is powered down)  
Power On  
Switches the server on.  
Immediate Power Off  
Powers the server down, regardless of the status of the operating  
system.  
Immediate Reset  
Completely restarts the server (cold start), regardless of the status of the  
operating system.  
Pulse NMI  
Initiates a non-maskable interrupt (NMI). A NMI is a processor interrupt  
that cannot be ignored by standard interrupt masking techniques in the  
system.  
Press Power Button  
Depending on the operating system installed and the action configured,  
you can trigger various actions by briefly pressing the power-off button.  
These actions could be shutting down the computer or switching it to  
standby mode or sleep mode.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
189  
 
Power Management  
Power Cycle  
Powers the server down completely and then powers it up again after a  
configured period. You can configure this time in the Power Cycle Delay  
field of the ASR&R Options group (see page 234).  
Graceful Power Off (Shutdown)  
Graceful shutdown and power off.  
This option is only available if ServerView agents are installed and  
signed onto the iRMC S2/S3 as “Connected”.  
Graceful Reset (Reboot)  
Graceful shutdown and reboot.  
This option is only available if ServerView agents are installed and  
signed onto the iRMC S2/S3 as “Connected”.  
Ê
Click Apply to start the required action.  
190  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Management  
7.7.2 Power Options -  
Configuring power management for the server  
The Power Options page allows you to define the server’s behavior after a power  
outage and specify the server’s power on/off times.  
Figure 104: Power Options page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
191  
 
Power Management  
Power Restore Policy - Specify behavior of the server after a power outage  
The Power Restore Policy group allows you to specify the server’s power  
management behavior after a power outage.  
Figure 105: Power Options page, Power Restore Policy  
Always power off  
The server always remains powered down after a power outage.  
Always power on  
The server is always powered up again after a power outage.  
Restore to powered state prior to power loss  
The power up/down status of the server is restored to the status prior to  
the power outage.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
The configured action will be performed after a power outage.  
192  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Management  
Power On/Off Time - Specify power on/off times for the server  
The input fields of the Power On/Off Time group allow you to specify the times at  
which the server is powered up/down for the individual days of the week or for  
specified times during the day.  
I
Specifications in the Everyday field take priority!  
The Trap fields also allow you to configure whether the iRMC S2/S3 sends an  
SNMP trap to the management console before a planned power-on / power-off  
of the managed server and, if so, how many minutes before the event this  
should be done. No traps are sent if you specify the value “0”.  
Figure 106: Power Options page, Power On/Off Time  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
193  
 
Power Management  
0 Watt Technology  
I
Please note:  
This feature is only supported by the iRMC S3.  
This feature is not supported for all PRIMERGY servers.  
The "0 Watt Technology" feature allows you to reduce the server’s standby  
power consumption to 0 watts. Every time the server is powered off, the server’s  
standby power consumption is reduced to 0 Watt (0 Watt mode).  
I
In the 0 Watt mode, the server can no longer be managed remotely. The  
server can only be powered on by pressing the Power button or the PSU  
Primary Resume button.  
However, by applying the Scheduled option (see page 196) you can  
specify a time interval at which the PSU is awoken from 0 Watt mode and  
thus both remote management and Wake-on-LAN (WOL) can be used.  
Figure 107: Power Options page, 0 Watt Technology  
Disabled  
Disables 0 Watt mode and remains in / switches to the standard power  
on/off mode. The server can be managed remotely at any time.  
194  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Management  
Enabled  
Enables 0 Watt mode.  
Even if Enabled has been configured, the 0 Watt mode is blocked in the  
following cases:  
Power-cycle request / power-on delay  
A power cycle request powers down the server without enabling  
0 Watt mode, i.e. 0 Watt mode will not be enabled in the delay between  
powering down and powering up during a power cycle:  
Any power-on request occurring within the delay causes the  
server to be powered on after the delay is over.  
If no power-on request occurred during the delay, the iRMC S3  
enables the 0 Watt mode after the delay time period has passed.  
Thermal power-on prohibition  
If the Temperature Monitoring mode (system thermal power on  
prohibition) has been configured in the BIOS/UEFI setup menu, 0 Watt  
mode will not be enabled.  
ASR&R  
Any ASR&R action currently reducing the retry counter prevents  
0 Watt mode from being enabled. This applies even if the server was  
finally powered off after the retry counter reached 0.  
Scheduled Power On/Off Time (see "Power On/Off Time - Specify  
As long as a Power On/Off timer configured in the iRMC S3 Power  
Options page is active, 0 Watt mode cannot be enabled.  
0 Watt mode also cannot be enabled if the Power On/Off timer gets  
deactivated while the server is powered off. In this case, only next  
power-off transition will enable 0 Watt mode. No scheduled Power  
On/Off timer will then prevent 0 Watt mode from being enabled.  
Global Error LED  
If the global Error LED indicates any problematic system health  
conditions, the iRMC S3 will not enable 0 Watt mode. This is because  
the server must be able to report system health problems even if  
powered off.  
iRMC S2/S3  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Management  
System Identification LED  
As long as the System Identification LED is on, the iRMC S3 will not  
enable 0 Watt mode.  
Advanced Video Redirection (AVR)  
If an AVR session is currently active, the iRMC S3 will not enable  
0 Watt mode. Once all AVR sessions have been finished (i.e, no AVR  
is active), the iRMC S3 will enable 0 Watt mode.  
Remote Storage Server (RSS), Telnet/SSH Sessions  
If an RSS session or an SSH/Telnet session is currently active, the  
iRMC S3 will not enable 0 Watt mode. This prevents the remote  
interface connections to the iRMC S3 from being lost.  
AC power fail  
If an AC fail occurs and the PSU (Power Supply Unit) is in the 0 Watt  
mode or in the scheduled mode, the PSU will return to system  
standby. Depending on the power restore policy settings (see  
page 192), the iRMC S3 determines whether the server is to be  
powered on. If the power restore policy is set to Always power off, an  
AC fail will never result in 0 Watt mode. 0 Watt mode may be reached  
after the next system power on.  
Scheduled  
Enables 0 Watt mode and also displays the 0 Watt Technology  
Administration Window. The 0 Watt Technology Administration Window allows  
you to specify a time interval at which the PSU is awoken from 0 Watt  
mode and thus both remote management and Wake-on-LAN (WOL) can  
be used.  
Figure 108: Power Options page, 0 Watt Technology Administration window  
Start Time  
Defines the beginning (hh:mm) of the time interval.  
196  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Management  
End Time  
Defines the end (hh:mm) of the time interval.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
197  
Power Management  
7.7.3 Power Supply Info - Power supply and IDPROM  
data for the FRU components  
The Power Supply Info page provides you with information on the power supply  
specifications and the IDPROM data of the FRUs of the server.  
The CSS Component column indicates for each of the components whether the  
CSS (Customer Self Service) functionality is supported.  
Figure 109: Power Supply Info page  
198  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Consumption  
7.8  
Power Consumption  
The Power Consumption entry contains the links to the pages for monitoring and  
controlling the power consumption of the managed server:  
page 191. (Not shown on all servers with iRMC S2/S3.)  
page 207 (Not shown on all servers with iRMC S2/S3.)  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
199  
 
Power Consumption  
7.8.1 Power Consumption Configuration - Configure  
power consumption of the server  
The Power Consumption Configuration page allows you to specify the mode the  
iRMC S2/S3 uses to control the power consumption of your PRIMERGY server.  
Figure 110: Power Consumption Configuration page  
I
Prerequisite:  
The following requirements must be met in order to configure power  
consumption control:  
The managed PRIMERGY server must support this feature.  
The Enhanced Speed Step or the Processor Power Management option  
must be enabled in the Advanced Menu of the BIOS setup.  
I
If you set the “Power Limit” power control mode in the Power Consumption  
Options group or in the Scheduled Power Consumption Configuration, the  
Power Limit Options group is also displayed (see page 202).  
200  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Consumption  
Power Consumption Options  
The Power Consumption Options group allows you to select the power control  
mode and specify whether the power consumption should be monitored over  
time.  
Power Control Mode  
Mode for controlling the power consumption of the managed server:  
Power Mgmt. Disabled:  
The iRMC S2/S3 allows the operating system to control power  
consumption.  
Best Performance:  
The iRMC S2/S3 controls the server to achieve best performance. In  
this event, power consumption can rise.  
Low Noise: (iRMC S3 only)  
The iRMC S3 controls the server to achieve the lowest possible noise  
emission. This feature is not supported for all PRIMERGY servers  
and only available for specific configurations.  
Minimum Power:  
The iRMC S2/S3 controls the server to achieve the lowest possible  
power consumption. In this event, performance is not always ideal.  
Power Limit:  
The Power Limit Options group is displayed (see "Power Limit Options"  
Scheduled:  
The iRMC S2/S3 controls power consumption in accordance with a  
schedule that you can define using the SCU (see "Scheduled Power  
Power Monitoring Units  
Unit of electrical power used to display power consumption:  
Watt  
BTU/h (British Thermal Unit/hour, 1 BTU/h corresponds to 0.293  
Watt).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
201  
Power Consumption  
Enable Power Monitoring  
If you enable this option, power consumption is monitored over time.  
I
Power monitoring is enabled by default as of Version 3.32 of the  
I firmware.  
This setting only takes effect on PRIMERGY servers that support  
power monitoring.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Scheduled Power Consumption Configuration  
The Scheduled Power Consumption Configuration group allows you to specify in  
detail the schedules and modes (operating-system-controlled, best  
performance, lowest power consumption) that the iRMC S2/S3 uses to control  
power consumption on the managed server.  
I
The Scheduled Power Consumption Configuration group only appears if you  
have enabled the power control mode scheduled in the Power Consumption  
I Options group.  
Configuration for scheduled power control mode assumes that the  
Enhanced Speed Step option has been enabled in the BIOS setup. If this is  
not the case, a message to this effect is displayed.  
If this message appears even though “Enhanced Speed Step” is  
enabled, this may be because:  
The CPU (e.g. low-power CPU) of the server does not support  
scheduled power control.  
The system is currently in the BIOS POST phase.  
202  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Consumption  
Figure 111: Power Consumption Configuration page (scheduled)  
Time 1  
Time [hh:ss] at which the iRMC S2/S3 starts power control as defined in  
Mode 1 on the relevant day of the week.  
Time 2  
Mode 1  
Mode 2  
Time [hh:ss] at which the iRMC S2/S3 starts power control as defined in  
Mode 2 on the relevant day of the week.  
Power consumption mode used by the iRMC S2/S3 for power control as  
of Time 1 on the relevant day of the week.  
Power consumption mode used by the iRMC S2/S3 for power control as  
I of Time 2 on the relevant day of the week.  
Set Time 1 < Time 2, otherwise the power control mode specified under  
Mode 2 will only be activated at Time 2 on the relevant day of the following  
I week.  
Specifications in the Everyday field take priority.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
203  
Power Consumption  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
I
You can also configure scheduled power control using the Server  
Power Limit Options  
The Power Limit Options group is displayed under the following circumstances:  
The power control mode Power Limit is selected and enabled in the Power  
Consumption Options group.  
The power control mode Scheduled is enabled in the Power Consumption  
Options group and the power control mode Power Limit is enabled at least  
once in the Scheduled Power Consumption Configuration group.  
The power limit then applies to all periods for which this power control mode  
is enabled in the Scheduled Power Consumption Configuration group.  
Figure 112: Power Consumption Configuration page (scheduled)  
Power Limit  
Maximum power consumption (in Watts).  
204  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Consumption  
Warning Threshold  
Threshold as a percentage of the maximum power consumption  
specified under Power Limit. When the threshold is reached, the action  
defined under Action Reaching Power Limit is performed.  
Power Limit Grace Period  
Period (in minutes) for which the system waits after the threshold has  
been reached until the action is performed.  
Action Reaching Power Limit  
Action to be performed after the threshold has been reached and the  
grace period has expired.  
Continue  
No action is performed.  
Graceful Power Off (Shutdown)  
Shut down the system "gracefully" and power it down.  
I
This option is only supported if ServerView agents are  
installed and signed onto the iRMC S2/S3 as “Connected”.  
Immediate Power Off  
The server is immediately powered down irrespective of the status  
of the operating system.  
Enable Dynamic Power Control  
The power limit is controlled dynamically. If this option is enabled, the  
iRMC S2/S3 controls the power consumption of the server system by  
reducing the CPU’s power consumption as soon as the Warning Threshold  
is reached.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
205  
Power Consumption  
7.8.2 Current Power Consumption -  
Show the current power consumption  
I
This view is not supported by all PRIMERGY servers with iRMC S2/S3.  
The Current Power Consumption page shows the current power consumption of  
the system components and of the overall system.  
Figure 113: Current Power Consumption page  
206  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Consumption  
7.8.3 Power Consumption History -  
Show server power consumption  
The Power Consumption History page charts the power consumption of your  
PRIMERGY server.  
I
This page is not shown on all PRIMERGY servers with iRMC S2/S3.  
Figure 114: Power Consumption History page  
iRMC S2/S3  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power Consumption  
Current Power Consumption  
I
This option is not supported for all PRIMERGY servers.  
Under Current Power Consumption you can see all the measurements for the  
server power consumption in the current interval: current, minimum, maximum  
and average power consumption.  
A graphical display also shows the current power consumption of the server  
compared with the maximum possible power consumption.  
Figure 115: Power Consumption History - Current Power Consumption  
Power History Options  
You specify the parameters for displaying the power consumption under Power  
History Options.  
Figure 116: Power Consumption History - Power History Options  
Power History Units  
Electrical power units:  
Watt  
BTU/h (British Thermal Unit/hour, 1 BTU/h corresponds to  
0.293 Watt).  
208  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Consumption  
Power History Period  
Period for which the power consumption is charted.  
The following intervals can be selected:  
1 hour  
Default.  
Measurements for the last hour (60 values). Since one  
measurement is generated every minute, this shows all the  
measurements of the last hour.  
12 hours  
Measurements for the last 12 hours. One measurement is shown  
for each five-minute period (every 5th measurement, 144 values  
in all).  
1 day  
Measurements for the last 24 hours. One measurement is shown  
for each 10-minute period (every 10th measurement, 144 values  
in all).  
1 week  
The measurements for the last week. One measurement per hour  
is shown (every 60th measurement, 168 values in all).  
2 weeks  
The measurements for the last month. One measurement is  
shown for each period of approx four hours (every 120th  
measurement, 168 values in all).  
1 month  
The measurements for the last 6 months. One measurement is  
shown for each period of approx one day (every 240th  
measurement, 180 values in all).  
1 year  
Measurements for the last 12 months. One measurement is  
shown for each two-day period (every 2880th measurement, 180  
values in all).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
209  
Power Consumption  
Enable Power Monitoring  
Specifies whether power monitoring is to be carried out.  
I
Power Monitoring) is enabled by default as of Version 3.32 of the  
I firmware.  
This setting only applies to PRIMERGY servers that support  
consumption logging.  
Ê
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Click Delete History to delete the displayed data.  
Power History Chart  
Power History Chart shows the power consumption of the managed server over  
time in the form of a graph (using the settings made under Power History  
Options). The difference between the actual power consumption and the power  
consumption displayed in the power history chart may amount to about 20%.  
Figure 117: Power Consumption History - Power History Chart  
210  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
7.9  
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
The “Sensors” entry provides you with pages which allow you to check the  
statuses of sensors of the managed server:  
To facilitate checking the status, the sensor status is not only shown in the form  
of the current value, but also using a color code and a status icon:  
Black (font color)/  
Orange (font color)/  
Red (font color)/  
The measured value is within the normal operational  
value range.  
The measured value has exceeded the warning  
threshold.  
System operation is not yet jeopardized.  
The measured value has exceeded the critical  
threshold.  
System operation may be jeopardized and there is a  
risk of loss of data integrity.  
Table 6: Status of the sensors  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
211  
 
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
7.9.1 Fans - Check fans  
The Fans page provides information on fans and their status.  
Figure 118: Fans page  
212  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
Fan Test - Test fans  
The Fan Test group allows you to specify a time at which the fan test is started  
automatically or to start the fan test explicitly.  
I
Instead of the formerly used full speed testing, most new systems now  
provide a modified fan test feature which performs the fan test with a  
speed near to the currently required speed. In this case, the fan test is no  
longer acoustically noticeable.  
Fan Check Time  
Enter the time at which the fan test is to be started automatically.  
Disable Fan Test  
Select this option to disable fan testing.  
Ê
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Click Start Fan Test to start the fan test explicitly.  
System Fans - Specify server behavior in the event that a fan fails  
The System Fans group provides you with information on the status of the fans.  
You can use the options or buttons to select individual fans or all the fans and  
specify whether the server should be shut down after a specified number of  
seconds if this fan fails.  
Select all  
Selects all fans.  
Deselect all  
All selections are cancelled.  
Ê
Select the fans for which you wish to define the behavior in the event of a  
fault.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
213  
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
Ê
Define the behavior in the event of a fault using the list at the bottom of the  
work area:  
Choose continue if the server is not to be shut down if the selected fans  
fail.  
Choose shutdown-and-power-off if the server is to be shut down and  
powered down if the selected fans fail. If you choose this option, you must  
also specify the time in seconds between failure of the fan and shutdown  
of the server (Shutdown Delay) in the field to the right of the list.  
I
In the case of redundant fans, shutdown is only initiated if more  
than one fan is faulty and shutdown-and-power-off is also set for  
these fans.  
Ê
Click Apply to the selected Fans to activate your settings for the selected fans.  
214  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
7.9.2 Temperature - Report the temperature of the server  
components  
The Temperature page provides information on the status of the temperature  
sensors which measure the temperature at the server components, such as the  
CPU and the Memory Module and the ambient temperature.  
Figure 119: Temperature page  
You can use the options or buttons to select individual temperature sensors or  
all the temperature sensors and specify whether the server is to be shut down  
if the critical temperature is reached at the selected sensors.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
215  
 
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
Select all  
Selects all temperature sensors.  
Deselect all  
All selections are cancelled.  
Ê
Ê
Select the sensors for which you wish to define the behavior in the event that  
the critical temperature is reached.  
Define the behavior in the event that the critical temperature is reached  
using the list at the bottom of the work area:  
Choose continue if the server is not to be shut down if the critical  
temperature is reached at the selected sensors.  
Choose shutdown-and-power-off if the server is to be shut down and  
powered down if the critical temperature is reached at the selected  
sensors.  
Ê
Click Apply to the selected Sensors to activate your settings for the selected  
temperature sensors.  
216  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
7.9.3 Voltages - Report voltage sensor information  
The Voltages page provides information on the status of voltage sensors  
assigned to the server components.  
Figure 120: Voltages page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
217  
 
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
7.9.4 Power Supply - Check power supply  
The Power Supply page provides information on the power supplied from the  
power supply units. For some server types, the Power Supply page also allows  
you to configure power supply redundancy settings.  
Figure 121: Power Supply page  
218  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
Power Supply Redundancy Configuration  
This functionality is not available with all servers.  
I
The Power Supply Redundancy Configuration group allows you to set the  
redundancy mode for the managed server. It depends on the servers  
capabilities which options are actually available.  
PSU Redundancy 1 + 1 Spare PSU  
System operation is guaranteed for 1 PSU fail in the case of 2 PSUs in  
total.  
PSU Redundancy 2+ 1 Spare PSU  
System operation is guaranteed for 1 PSU fail in the case of 3 PSUs in  
total.  
PSU Redundancy 3+ 1 Spare PSU  
System operation is guaranteed for 1 PSU fail in the case of 4 PSUs in  
total.  
AC Redundancy 2 + 2 (2 AC sources)  
2 of the 4 PSUs are each connected to a separate AC source. This  
ensures that the system can continue operation even if a power line or a  
single PSU fails.  
AC Redundancy 1 + 1 (2 AC sources)  
Each PSU (of 2 PSUs in total) is connected to a separate AC source. This  
ensures that the system can continue operation even if a power line or a  
single PSU fails.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
219  
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
7.9.5 Component Status -  
Check status of the server components  
The Component Status page provides information on the status of the server  
components. The CSS Component column indicates for each of the components  
whether the CSS (Customer Self Service) functionality is supported.  
Figure 122: Component Status page  
220  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
Entries with Designation "iRMC", "Agent", "BIOS", or "VIOM"  
Entries with the Designation "iRMC", "Agent", "BIOS", or "VIOM" indicate that the  
iRMC S2/S3, the agent, the BIOS, or VIOM has detected an error. It does not  
mean that the iRMC S2/S3, the agent, the BIOS, or VIOM itself is defective.  
Entries with Designation "HDD" and "HDD<n>, agentless HDD monitoring  
("out-of-band" HDD monitoring)  
Entries with the Designation "HDD" or "HDD<n>" (with n = 1, 2, ...) indicate the  
statuses of Hard Disk Drives (HDD):  
The entry with Designation "HDD" indicates the overall HDD status of the  
server by summarizing the statuses of the individual HDDs.  
The overall HDD status of the server is read and reported to the iRMC S2/S3  
by the ServerView agents and the ServerView RAID Manager.  
An entry with Designation "HDD<n>" (where n = 1, 2, ...) indicates the status  
of an individual HDD.  
I
Please note:  
This feature is only supported by the iRMC S3.  
This feature only supported if the managed PRIMERGY server  
supports the "agentless HDD monitoring" function (also known as  
"out-of-band HDD monitoring").  
If these requirements are met, the HDD<n> status of each individual  
HDD is reported directly to the iRMC S3, i.e. without using the  
ServerView agents.  
Figure 123: Status display for individual HDDs  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
221  
Sensors - Check status of the sensors  
I
The precise entries displayed in the Component Status Sensor Information  
table, therefore, depend on the server state and whether the server  
supports "agentless HDD monitoring":  
The entry with Designation "HDD" only shows a status in the Signal  
Status column if the ServerView agents and the ServerView RAID  
Manager are installed and running on the managed server.  
Otherwise, "N/A" (not available) is displayed in the Signal Status  
column instead.  
The entries with Designation "HDD<n> (with n = 1, 2, ...)" are only  
displayed if the managed server supports "agentless HDD  
monitoring".  
222  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
7.10 System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
The Event Log entry in the navigation area contains the links to the pages for  
viewing and configuring the IPMI event log (system event log, SEL) and the  
iRMC S2/S3 internal event log:  
The internal event log contains entries providing information on audit events  
(logon events, AVR connection events, etc.) and additional information (e.g.  
IPv6 related information and LDAP user names).  
The IPMI SEL contains entries providing information on events like operating  
system boots / shutdowns, fan failures, and iRMC S2/S3 firmware flashes.  
Colored icons are assigned to the various event / error categories to improve  
clarity:  
Critical  
Major  
Minor  
Informational  
Customer Self Service (CSS) event  
Table 7: System event log / internal event log content - error categories  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
223  
 
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
7.10.1 System Event Log Content -  
Show information on the SEL and the SEL entries  
The System Event Log Content page provides information on the IPMI SEL and  
displays the SEL entries. The IPMI SEL contains entries providing information  
on events like operating system boots / shutdowns, fan failures, and  
iRMC S2/S3 firmware flashes.  
The CSS Event column indicates for each of the events whether the event was  
triggered by a CSS (Customer Self Service) component.  
Figure 124: System Event Log Content page  
224  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
System Event Log Information  
The System Event Log Information group informs you of the number of entries in  
the IPMI SEL. It also indicates the time when the last entries were added or  
deleted.  
Figure 125: System Event Log Content page, System Event Log Information  
Clear Event Log  
Click Clear Event Log to clear all the entries in the IPMI SEL.  
Save Event Log  
After you have clicked Save Event Log, the iRMC S2/S3 allows you to  
download the file iRMC S2/S3_EventLog.sel, which contains the IPMI SEL  
entries.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
225  
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
System Event Log Content  
The System Event Log Content group displays the SEL entries filtered by severity  
class.  
I
You can modify the filter criteria for the duration of the current session in  
the System Event Log Content group. However, the settings you make here  
are only valid until the next logout. After that, the default settings apply  
again.  
Figure 126: System Event Log Content page, System Event Log Content  
Display Critical, Display Major, Display Minor, Display Info, CSS only  
If you wish, you can choose one or more severity levels other than the  
default values here.  
Show Resolutions  
If you choose this option, a proposal for solution will be displayed for each  
SEL entry of severity level Critical or Major.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings for the duration of the current session.  
226  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
7.10.2 Internal Event Log Content -  
Show information on the internal eventlog and the  
associated entries  
The Internal Event Log Content page provides information on the internal eventlog  
and displays the associated entries. The internal event log comprises audit  
events (logon events, AVR connection events, etc.) and additional information  
(e.g. IPv6 related information and LDAP user names).  
Figure 127: InternalEvent Log Content page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
227  
 
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
Internal Event Log Information  
The Internal Event Log Information group informs you of the number of entries in  
the internal event log. It also indicates the time when the last entries were added  
or deleted.  
Figure 128: System Event Log Content page, System Event Log Information  
Clear Internal Event Log  
Click Clear Internal Event Log to clear all the entries in the internal event  
log.  
Save Internal Event Log  
After you have clicked Save Internal Event Log, the iRMC S2/S3 allows you  
to download the file iRMC S2_InternalEventLog.sel / the file  
iRMC S3_InternalEventLog.sel, which contains the entries of the internal  
event log.  
228  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
Internal Event Log Content  
The Internal Event Log Content group displays the internal eventlog entries  
filtered by severity class.  
I
You can modify the filter criteria for the duration of the current session in  
the Internal Event Log Content group. However, the settings you make  
here are only valid until the next logout. After that, the default settings  
apply again.  
Figure 129: System Event Log Content page, System Event Log Content  
Display Critical, Display Major, Display Minor, Display Info  
If you wish, you can choose one or more severity levels other than the  
default values here.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings for the duration of the current session.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
229  
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
7.10.3 Event Log Configuration -  
Configure IPMI SEL and internal event log  
On the Event Log Configuration page, you can configure the IPMI system event  
log (SEL) and the internal eventlog.  
You can configure for each of the event logs  
the entries which are displayed by default on the System Event Log Content  
page (see page 224) and on the Internal Event Log Content page (see  
page 227), respectively.  
whether IPMI SEL and internal eventlog are organized as a ring buffer or a  
linear buffer.  
Figure 130: Event Log Configuration page  
230  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
IPMI Event Log Configuration  
DefaultILCD panel display filtering  
If a ServerView Local Service Display module is fitted in the  
managed PRIMERGY server, you can also select the error  
severities for displaying the SEL on the ServerView Local Service  
Display. (This selection is independent of the selection you have  
made for the SEL entries displayed on the System Event Log Content  
page.)  
Display Critical, Display Major, Display Minor, Display Info, CSS only  
Here you select one or more severity levels for which event log  
entries should be displayed by default on the on the ServerView  
Local Service Display.  
Default Web interface display filtering  
Display Critical, Display Major, Display Minor, Display Info, CSS only  
Here you select one or more severity levels for which event log  
entries should be displayed by default on the on the  
System Event Log Content page (see page 224).  
Show Resolutions  
If you choose this option, the cause of the entry and a proposal for  
resolution will be displayed for each SEL entry of severity level  
Critical, Major, or Minor.  
Ring Buffer  
The event log is organized as a ring buffer.  
Linear Buffer  
The event log is organized as a linear buffer.  
I
When the linear event log has been completely filled, it is not  
possible to add any further entries.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
231  
System Event Log and Internal Event Log  
Internal Event Log Configuration  
Display Critical, Display Major, Display Minor, Display Info  
Here you select one or more severity levels for which event log entries  
should be displayed by default on the on the Internal Event Log Content  
page (see page 227).  
Ring Buffer  
The event log is organized as a ring buffer.  
Linear Buffer  
The event log is organized as a linear buffer.  
I
When the linear event log has been completely filled, it is not  
possible to add any further entries.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Helpdesk Information  
Figure 131: Helpdesk Information  
Help desk  
String used to display the Help Desk  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
232  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Server Management Information - Configuring the server settings  
7.11 Server Management Information -  
Configuring the server settings  
The Server Management Information page allows you to configure the following  
settings on the server:  
ASR&R (automatic server reconfiguration and restart) settings for the server  
(see page 234)  
Watchdog settings (see page 235)  
HP System Insight Manager (HP SIM) integration (see page 237)  
Figure 132: Server Management Information page  
iRMC S2/S3  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Server Management Information - Configuring the server settings  
ASR&R Options - Configure ASR&R settings  
The ASR&R Options group allows you to configure the ASR&R (automatic server  
reconfiguration and restart) settings for the server.  
I
The settings made on the ASR&R Options group become active the next  
time the managed server is started.  
Figure 133: Server Management Information page, ASR&R Options  
Retry counter Max (0 - 7)  
Maximum number of restart attempts that should be permitted for the  
server after a critical error (up to 7).  
Retry counter (0 - Max)  
Number of restart attempts that a server should attempt after a critical  
error (maximum value is the value set under Retry counter Max).  
BIOS recovery flash bit  
Enables/disables the BIOS recovery flash bit:  
Enabled  
The next time the system is booted, the BIOS is automatically  
flashed.  
Disabled  
The next time the system is booted, the BIOS is not automatically  
flashed.  
I
The Enabled setting is of value if the operating system no longer  
boots after the firmware has been updated. A BIOS recovery flash  
is then performed automatically the next time the system is booted  
from the DOS floppy (or a DOS floppy image).  
After a BIOS recovery flash has been performed successfully,  
reset the BIOS Recovery Flash bit to disabled.  
234  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Server Management Information - Configuring the server settings  
Power Cycle Delay (0 - 15)  
Time (in seconds) between powering down and powering up during a  
power cycle.  
Ê
Click Apply to save your settings.  
The configured settings are saved and the actions which have been  
configured are performed in the appropriate circumstances.  
Watchdog Settings - Configure software watchdog and boot watchdog  
The Watchdog Settings group allows you configure the software watchdog and the  
boot watchdog.  
I
The settings made on the ASR&R Options group become active the next  
time the managed server is started.  
Figure 134: Server Management Information page, Watchdog Options  
The software watchdog  
monitors the activities of system using the ServerView agents. The software  
watchdog is activated when the ServerView agents and the operating system  
have been completely initialized.  
The ServerView agents contact the iRMC S2/S3 at defined intervals. If no more  
messages are received from a ServerView agent, it is assumed that the system  
is no longer functioning correctly.  
You can specify an action to be performed if this happens.  
The boot watchdog monitors the phase between startup of the system and the  
time at which the ServerView agents become available.  
If the ServerView agents do not establish a connection to the iRMC S2/S3 of the  
server within a specified time, it is assumed that the boot process has not been  
successful.  
You can specify an action to be performed if this happens.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
235  
 
Server Management Information - Configuring the server settings  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Check or uncheck the option(s) under Enabled for the Software Watchdog  
and/or Boot Watchdog.  
Ê
If you have activated either of these options, you can configure the following  
settings after Software Watchdog and/or Boot Watchdog:  
Continue  
No action is performed when the watchdog has expired, i.e. the  
server continues to run. An entry is made in the event log.  
Reset  
The server management software triggers a system reset.  
Power Cycle  
The server is powered down and immediately powered up again.  
Ê
Ê
As appropriate, enter the time (in minutes) after which this action is to be  
performed following after timeout delay.  
I
The boot watchdog must wait until the system has been started. You  
therefore have to specify a sufficient period for after timeout delay (1 -  
100).  
Click Apply button.  
The configured settings are saved and the actions which have been  
configured are performed in the appropriate circumstances.  
236  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Server Management Information - Configuring the server settings  
HP System Insight Manager (HP SIM) Integration Options -  
Configure HP SIM integration  
The HP System Insight Manager (HP SIM) Integration Options group allows you to  
configure whether the iRMC S2/S3 device will return some identifying  
information in response to an unauthenticated XML query sent from the HP  
System Insight Manager.  
Figure 135: Page Server Management Information - HP SIM Integration Options  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Activate/deactivate the HP SIM Integration Disabled option in order to  
deactivate or to activate HP SIM integration.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
237  
 
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
7.12 Network Settings -  
Configure the LAN parameters  
The Network Settings entry brings together the links to the pages you use to  
configure the LAN parameters of the iRMC S2/S3:  
238  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
7.12.1 Network Interface Settings -  
Configure Ethernet settings on the iRMC S2/S3  
The Network Interface page allows you to view and change the Ethernet settings  
for the iRMC S2/S3.  
Figure 136: Network Interface page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
239  
   
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
V
CAUTION!  
Contact the network administrator responsible for the system before you  
change the Ethernet settings.  
If you make illegal Ethernet settings for the iRMC S2/S3, you will only be  
able to access the iRMC S2/S3 using special configuration software, the  
I serial interface or via the BIOS.  
Only users with the Configure iRMC S2/S3 Settings permission are allowed  
to edit Ethernet settings (see chapter "User management for the  
Network Interface Settings  
MAC Address  
The MAC address of the iRMC S2/S3 is displayed here.  
LAN Speed  
LAN speed. The following options are available:  
Auto Negotiation  
1000 MBit/s Full Duplex (depending on the server hardware)  
100 MBit/s Full Duplex  
100 MBit/s Half Duplex  
10 MBit/s Full Duplex  
10 MBit/s Half Duplex  
If Auto Negotiation is selected, the onboard LAN controller assigned to the  
iRMC S2/S3 autonomously determines the correct transfer speed and  
duplex method for the network port it is connected to.  
LAN PoIrt  
This option is not supported for all PRIMERGY servers.  
On some PRIMERGY server models, the LAN interface of the installed  
system NIC (network interface card) can be set up  
as shared LAN for shared operation with the system  
or  
as a service LAN for exclusive use as a management LAN.  
240  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
IPv4 Enabled  
Enables/disables IPv4 addressing for the iRMC S2/S3. If IPv4  
addressing is enabled, the IPv4 configuration group will be displayed (see  
below).  
You cannot disable IPv4 addressing if the iRMC S2/S3 is currently  
accessed via IPv4.  
IPv6 Enabled  
Enables/disables IPv6 addressing for the iRMC S2/S3. If IPv6  
addressing is enabled, the IPv6 configuration group will be displayed (see  
below).  
You cannot disable IPv6 addressing if the iRMC S2/S3 is currently  
accessed via IPv6.  
IPv4 configuration  
The IPv4 configuration group allows you to configure the IPv4 settings for the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
IP Address  
IPv4 address of the iRMC S2/S3 in the LAN. This address is different  
from the IP address of the managed server.  
I
If you are working with a static address (DHCP enable option not  
activated) then you can enter this here. Otherwise (if the  
DHCP enable option is activated), the iRMC S2/S3 only uses the  
field to display the address.  
Subnet Mask  
Subnet mask of the iRMC S2/S3 in the LAN.  
Gateway  
IPv4 address of the default gateway in the LAN.  
DHCP Enabled  
If you activate this option, the iRMC S2/S3 gets its LAN settings from a  
DHCP server on the network.  
I
Do not activate the DHCP option if no DHCP server is available on  
the network.  
If you activate the DHCP option and there is no DHCP server  
available on the network, the iRMC S2/S3 goes into a search loop  
(i.e. it continues searching for a DHCP server until it finds one).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
241  
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
The (configured) iRMC S2/S3 can be registered with a DNS  
server by an appropriately configured DHCP server (see section  
IPv6 configuration  
The IPv6 configuration group allows you to manually configure an IPv6 address  
for the iRMC S2/S3 in addition to the link-local address, which is always  
assigned automatically to the iRMC S2/S3 by using stateless autoconfiguration.  
I
With ipv6 addressing, DHCP is not supported for the iRMC S2/S3.  
Figure 137: Network Interface page - manual IPv6 configuration disabled  
Manual IPv6 configuration  
This option is disabled by default.  
If you enable the Manual IPv6 configuration option, the IPv6 configuration  
group displays additional parameters that allow you to manually  
configure a routable IPv6 address for the iRMC S2/S3:  
Figure 138: Network Interface page - manual IPv6 configuration  
Interface Identifier Source  
Specifies from which source the interface identifier part of the IPv6  
address is taken.  
242  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
Part of the specified static address  
Part of the static address specified under IPv6 Static Address.  
EUI-64 (based on MAC address)  
EUI-64 standard conform representation of the MAC address of  
the iRMC S2/S3.  
IPv6 Static Address  
Static IPv6 address for the iRMC S2/S3.  
Prefix Length  
Length of the IPv6 prefix.  
IPv6 Static Gateway  
Static IPv6 address of the default IPv6 gateway in the LAN.  
IPv6 Gateway Source  
IPv6 gateway that is used by the iRMC S2/S3.  
Static IPv6 Gateway  
Gateway specified under IPv6 Static Gateway.  
Automatic (Router specific)  
The gateway is determined automatically by the Router.  
VLAN Configuration  
VLAN Enabled  
This option allows you to activate VLAN support for the iRMC S2/S3.  
VLAN Id  
VLAN ID of the virtual network (VLAN) the iRMC S2/S3 belongs to.  
Permitted value range: 1 ÎVLAN Id Î4094.  
VLAN Priority  
VLAN priority (user priority) of the iRMC S2/S3 in the VLAN specified by  
VLAN Id.  
Permitted value range: 0 ÎVLAN Priority Î7 (default: 0).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
243  
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
Advanced TCP configuration  
Max TCP Segment Lifetime  
Maximum lifetime (in seconds) of TCP/IP packet (Default: 32 seconds).  
TCP Connection Timeout  
Timeout value (in seconds) of the TCP connection (Default: 32 seconds).  
Max. Transmission Unit (MTU)  
Maximum packet size (in bytes) of the TCP/IP data packages that will be  
accepted by the TCP/IP connection. (Default: 3000 Bytes).  
Ê
Click Apply to activate the configured Ethernet settings.  
244  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
7.12.2 Ports and Network Services -  
Configuring ports and network services  
The Ports and Network Services page allows you to view and modify the  
configuration settings for ports and network services.  
Figure 139: Ports and Network Services page  
I
Configuration is not supported for ports where the input fields are  
deactivated in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
245  
   
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
Ports for web-based access  
Session Timeout  
Period of inactivity (in seconds) after which the session is automatically  
closed. The login page of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface then appears,  
and you can log in again as required (see page 136).  
I
Your session will not automatically be closed if it is inactive when  
the time specified in Session Timeout has elapsed if you enter a  
value for the refresh interval which is less than the Session Timeout  
in the Refresh every ... seconds field (see page 247).  
HTTP Port  
HTTP port of the iRMC S2/S3  
Default port number: 80  
Configurable: yes  
Enabled by default: yes  
Communication direction: inbound and outbound  
HTTPS Port  
HTTPS (HTTP Secure) port of the iRMC S2/S3  
Default port number: 443  
Configurable: yes  
Enabled by default: yes  
Communication direction: inbound and outbound  
Force HTTPS  
If you enable the Force HTTPS option, users can only establish a secure  
connection to the iRMC S2/S3 on the HTTPS port specified in the entry  
field.  
If you disable the Force HTTPS option, users can establish a non-secure  
connection to the iRMC S2/S3 on the HTTP port specified in the entry  
field.  
I
If the SSL certificate has expired, a message to this effect is  
issued in the browser.  
Enable Auto Refresh  
If you activate this option, the contents of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
are automatically refreshed periodically. Specify the refresh interval in  
the Refresh every ... seconds field.  
246  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
Refresh every ... seconds  
Length (in seconds) of the interval for automatically refreshing the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface.  
I
If you enter a value for the refresh interval which is less than the  
Session Timeout (see page 246), your session will not automatically  
be closed when the time specified in Session Timeout has elapsed  
in the event of inactivity.  
Ports for text-based access  
Telnet Port  
Telnet port of the iRMC S2/S3  
Default port number: 3172  
Configurable: yes  
Enabled by default: no  
Communication direction: inbound and outbound  
Session Drop Time  
Period of inactivity (in seconds) after which a Telnet connection is  
automatically cleared.  
SSH Port  
SSH (Secure Shell) port of the iRMC S2/S3  
Default port number: 22  
Configurable: yes  
Enabled by default: yes  
Communication direction: inbound and outbound  
Telnet enabled  
If you enable the Telnet Enabled option, users can establish a connection  
to the iRMC S2/S3 on the Telnet port specified in the entry field.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
247  
 
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
VNC ports  
Standard Port  
VNC port of the iRMC S2/S3 for secure and non-secure Advanced Video  
Redirection (AVR)  
Port number: 80  
Hard-configured  
Enabled by default: yes  
Communication direction: inbound  
Secure Port (SSL)  
VNC port of the iRMC S2/S3 for the SSL-secured transfer of mouse and  
keyboard input for AVR.  
Port number: 443  
Hard-configured.  
Enabled by default: yes  
Communication direction: inbound  
Remote Storage Ports  
Standard Port  
Default remote storage port of the iRMC S2/S3  
Default port number: 5901  
Configurable: yes  
Enabled by default: yes  
I Communication direction: outbound to the remote workstation  
As of iRMC S2/S3 firmware version 5.00, the Remote Storage port is  
used only for the Remote Storage server and client-internal  
communications. For integrated Remote Storage, the http port is used.  
Ê
Click Apply to store the configured settings.  
248  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
7.12.3 DNS Configuration - Configuring DNS for the  
iRMC S2/S3  
The DNS Configuration page allows you to activate the Domain Name Service  
(DNS) for the iRMC S2/S3 and to configure a host name for the iRMC S2/S3.  
Figure 140: DNS Configuration page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
249  
   
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
DNS Settings  
The DNS Settings group allows you to activate the Domain Name Service (DNS)  
for the iRMC S2/S3. This makes it possible to use symbolic DNS names instead  
of IP addresses for configuring the iRMC S2/S3.  
Figure 141: DNS Configuration page - DNS Settings  
DNS enabled  
Enables/disables DNS for the iRMC S2/S3.  
Obtain DNS configuration from DHCP  
If you activate this option, the IP addresses of the DNS servers are  
obtained automatically from the DHCP server.  
In this event, up to five DNS servers are supported.  
If you do not enable this setting, you can enter up to five DNS server  
addresses manually under DNS-Server 1 - DNS-Server 5.  
DNS Domain  
If the option Obtain DNS configuration from DHCP is disabled, specify the  
name of the default domain for requests to the DNS server(s).  
DNS Server 1 .. 5  
If the Obtain DNS configuration from DHCP option is disabled, you can  
enter the names of up to five DNS servers here.  
DNS Retries  
Number of DNS retries.  
DNS Timeout  
Timeout (in seconds) for a DNS response.  
Ê
Click Apply to store the configured settings.  
250  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
DNS Name  
The DNS Name group allows you to configure a host name for the iRMC S2/S3  
and thus use “dynamic DNS”. Dynamic DNS allows DHCP servers to  
autonomously pass on the IP address and system name of a network  
component to DNS servers to facilitate identification.  
Figure 142: DNS Configuration page - DNS Name  
Register DHCP Address in DNS via DHCP Server  
This option is disabled if IPv6 addressing is used.  
Enables/disables the transfer of the DHCP name to the DHCP server for  
the iRMC S2/S3 and the DNS registration via DHCP server.  
Register full domain name (FQDN) via DHCP server in DNS  
This option is disabled if IPv6 addressing is used.  
Enables/disables the transfer of the FQDN (Fully Qualified Domain  
Name) to the DHCP server for the iRMC S2/S3 and the DNS registration  
via DHCP server.  
DNS Update Enabled  
Enables/disables update of DNS records via Dynamic DNS.  
Use iRMC S2/S3 name instead of server hostname  
The iRMC S2/S3 name specified in the iRMC S2/S3 Name entry field is  
used for the iRMC S2/S3 instead of the server name.  
Add Serial Number  
The last 3 bytes of the MAC address of the iRMC S2/S3 are appended  
to the DHCP name of the iRMC S2/S3.  
Add Extension  
The extension specified in the Extension entry field is appended to the  
DHCP name of the iRMC S2/S3.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
251  
Network Settings - Configure the LAN parameters  
iRMC S2/S3 Name  
iRMC S2/S3 name passed to DHCP for the iRMC S2/S3 in place of the  
server name. Depending on the related options, the iRMC S2/S3 name  
is used as part of the DNS name.  
Extension  
Name extension for the iRMC S2/S3.  
DNS Name  
Shows the configured DNS name for the iRMC S2/S3.  
Ê
Click Apply to store the configured settings.  
252  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alerting - Configure alerting  
7.13 Alerting - Configure alerting  
The Alerting entry contains the links to the pages you use to configure alerting  
for the iRMC S2/S3:  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
253  
   
Alerting - Configure alerting  
7.13.1 SNMP Trap Alerting -  
Configure SNMP trap alerting  
The SNMP Trap Alerting page allows you to view and configure the settings for  
SNMP trap alerting.  
I
Forwarding of SNMP traps to up to seven SNMP servers is supported.  
Figure 143: SNMP Trap Alerting page  
SNMP Community  
Name of the SNMP community.  
Ê
Click Apply to accept the community name.  
SNMP Server1 .. SNMP Server7 (trap destinations)  
DNS names or IP addresses of the servers that belong to this community  
and are to be configured as Trap Destinations.  
Ê
Ê
Click Apply to activate the SNMP server as a trap destination.  
Click Test to test the connection to the SNMP server.  
Ê
Click Apply All to activate all the settings if appropriate.  
254  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Alerting - Configure alerting  
7.13.2 Serial / Modem Alerting -  
Configure alerting via modem  
I
The Serial / Modem Alerting page is only available with the iRMC S2.  
The Serial / Modem Alerting page allows you to configure how alerts are  
forwarded via a modem.  
Figure 144: Serial / Modem Alerting page  
Modem Alerting Enable  
Enables or disables serial / modem alerting.  
Modem Init String  
Please refer to your modem documentation for details on this entry.  
Modem Reset/Hangup String  
Please refer to your modem documentation for details on this entry.  
Modem Dial Prefix  
This entry will depend on the type of connection you have.  
iRMC S2/S3  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Alerting - Configure alerting  
Provider Phone Number  
Enter the name of the SMS server.  
Handy/Pager Phone Number  
Enter the name of the mobile phone.  
Handy/Pager Type  
You can choose between:  
Signal Pager  
Numeric Pager  
Alpha pager  
SMS  
DoCoMo  
SMS Message Length Limit  
You can choose between 80 or 140 as the maximum length.  
SMS Protocol Type  
Enable the option corresponding to the mobile phone network used.  
Ê
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Click Test to send a test alert.  
256  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alerting - Configure alerting  
7.13.3 Email Alerting - Configure email alerting  
The Email Alerting page allows you to configure the settings for  
email alerting.  
I
Configuration of two mail servers is supported.  
Email alerting can be specified individually for each user (see section  
Figure 145: Email Alerting page  
iRMC S2/S3  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Alerting - Configure alerting  
Global Email Paging Configuration - Configure global email settings  
The Global Email Paging Configuration group allows you to configure the global  
email settings.  
Figure 146: Email Alerting page, Global Email Configuration  
Email Alerting Enable  
Activate this option.  
SMTP Retries (0 - 7)  
Number of SMTP retries.  
SMTP Retry Delay (0 - 255)  
Time (in seconds) between SMTP retries.  
SMTP Response Timeout  
Timeout (in seconds) for an SMTP response.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
258  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alerting - Configure alerting  
Primary SMTP Server Configuration - Configure primary mail server  
The Primary SMTP Server Configuration group allows you to configure the  
primary server (SMTP server).  
Figure 147: Email Alerting page, Primary SMTP Server Configuration  
SMTP Server  
IP address of the primary mail server  
I
You can activate the Domain Name Service (DNS) for the iRMC  
iRMC S2/S3" on page 249). You can then use a symbolic name  
instead of the IP address.  
SMTP Port  
SMTP port of the mail server  
Auth Type  
Authentication type for connecting the iRMC S2/S3 to the mail server:  
None  
No authentication for the connection.  
SMTP AUTH (RFC 2554)  
Authentication according to RFC 2554: SMTP Service Extension for  
Authentication.  
In this case, the following information is required:  
Auth User Name  
User name for authentication on the mail server  
Auth Password  
Password for authentication on the mail server  
Confirm Password  
Confirm the password entered.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
259  
 
Alerting - Configure alerting  
Secondary SMTP Server Configuration - Configure secondary mail server  
The Secondary SMTP Server Configuration group allows you to configure the  
secondary server (SMTP server).  
Figure 148: Email Alerting page - Secondary SMTP Server Configuration  
SMTP Server  
IP address of the secondary mail server  
I
You can activate the Domain Name Service (DNS) for the iRMC  
iRMC S2/S3" on page 249). You can then use a symbolic name  
instead of the IP address.  
SMTP Port  
SMTP port of the mail server  
Auth Type  
Authentication type for connecting the iRMC S2/S3 to the mail server:  
None  
No authentication for the connection.  
SMTP AUTH (RFC 2554)  
Authentication according to RFC 2554: SMTP Service Extension for  
Authentication.  
In this case, the following information is required:  
Auth User Name  
User name for authentication on the mail server  
Auth Password  
Password for authentication on the mail server  
Confirm Password  
Confirm the password entered.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
260  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Alerting - Configure alerting  
Mail Format dependent Configuration -  
Configure mail-format-dependent settings  
The Mail Format dependent Configuration group allows you to configure the mail-  
format-dependent settings. You specify the mail format for each user using the  
New User Configuration - User <Name> Configuration - Email Format Configuration  
page (see page 270).  
The following email formats are supported:  
Standard  
Fixed Subject  
ITS-Format  
Fujitsu REMCS Format  
Figure 149: Email Alerting page, Mail Format dependent Configuration  
Some entry fields are disabled depending on the mail format.  
From  
Sender identification iRMC S2/S3.  
Active for all mail formats.  
I
If the string entered here contains an “@”, the string is interpreted  
as a valid email address. Otherwise, “admin@<ip-address>” is  
used as the valid email address.  
Subject  
Fixed subject for the alert mails.  
Only active for the Fixed Subject mail format (see page 270).  
Message  
Type of message (email).  
Only active for the Fixed Subject mail format (see page 270).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
261  
 
Alerting - Configure alerting  
Admin Name  
Name of the administrator responsible (optional).  
Only active for the ITS mail format (see page 270).  
Admin Phone  
Phone number of the administrator responsible (optional).  
Only active for the ITS mail format (see page 270).  
REMCS Id  
This ID is an additional server ID, similar to the serial number.  
Only active for the mail format Fujitsu REMCS-Format.  
Server URL  
A URL under which the server is accessible under certain conditions. You  
have to enter the URL manually.  
Only active for the Standard mail format.  
Ê
Click Apply to store your settings.  
262  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management  
7.14 User Management  
The User Management entry contains the links to the pages for local user  
management as well as for the configuration of the directory service for global  
user management (LDAP configuration):  
7.14.1 iRMC S2/S3 User - local user management on the  
iRMC S2/S3  
The iRMC S2/S3 User page contains a table showing all the configured users:  
Each line contains the data for one configured user. The user names are  
implemented in the form of links. Clicking on a user name opens the  
User “<name>” Configuration window (see page 266), in which you can view or  
modify the settings for this user.  
I
User ID 1 (“null user”) is reserved for the IPMI standard and is therefore  
unavailable for user management on the iRMC S2/S3.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
263  
     
User Management  
Figure 150: User Management page  
Delete  
The table of configured users includes a Delete button after each user  
entry. Click this button to delete the associated user after confirming this  
choice.  
New User  
When you click this button, the  
New User Configuration page opens (see page 265). You can configure a  
new user here.  
264  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Management  
7.14.1.1 New User Configuration - Configuring a new user  
The New User Configuration page allows you to configure the basic settings for a  
new user.  
You will find explanations of the fields and selection lists on the  
New User Configuration page as of page 267 under the description of the User  
“<name>” Configuration page.  
In figure 151 you can see the configuration of a user with the name “User3”.  
Figure 151: User Management - New User Configuration page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
265  
     
User Management  
7.14.1.2 User “<name>” Configuration - User configuration (details)  
The User “<name>” Configuration page allows you to view, modify and extend  
the settings for a user.  
In figure 152 you can see the configuration of the user created in figure 151.  
I
The user ID is shown in brackets after the user name.  
Figure 152: User Management - User “<name>” Configuration page  
266  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
User Management  
User Information - Configuring user access data  
The User Information group allows you to configure the access data for the user.  
Figure 153: User Management - User “<name>” Configuration page, User Information  
User Enabled  
Disable this option to lock the user.  
Name  
Enter the name of the user.  
Password  
Enter the user password.  
Confirm Password  
Confirm the password by entering it again here.  
User Description  
Enter a general description of the configured user here.  
User Shell  
Select the desired user shell here.  
The following options are available:  
SMASH CLP  
Remote Manager  
IPMI Terminal Mode  
None  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
267  
 
User Management  
Privileges / Permissions - Assigning user privileges  
The Privileges / Permissions group allows you to configure the channel-specific  
user privileges.  
Figure 154: User Management - User “<name>” Configuration page, Privilege / Permissions  
LAN Channel Privilege  
Assign a privilege group for a LAN channel to the user here:  
User  
Operator  
Administrator  
OEM  
Refer to section "User permissions" on page 68 for information on the  
permissions associated with the privilege groups.  
Serial Channel Privilege  
Assign a privilege group for a serial channel to the user here: The same  
privilege groups are available as for LAN Channel Privilege.  
In addition to the channel-specific permissions, you can also individually assign  
users the following channel-independent permissions:  
Configure User Accounts  
Permission to configure local user access data.  
Configure iRMC S2/S3 Settings  
Permission to configure the iRMC S2/S3 settings.  
Video Redirection enabled  
Permission to use Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) in “View Only” and  
“Full Control” mode.  
Remote Storage enabled  
Permission to use the Remote Storage functionality.  
268  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
User SSHv2 public key upload from file  
The User SSHv2 public Key uploag from file group allows you to load an user  
SSHv2 public key from a local file.  
Figure 155: User Management - User “<name>” Configuration page, User SSHv2 public key  
upload from file  
For further details on SSHv2 public key authentication for iRMC S2/S3 users  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
269  
User Management  
Email Configuration - Configure user-specific email settings  
The Email Configuration group allows you to configure the user-specific settings  
governing the email format.  
Figure 156: User Management - User “<name>” Configuration page, Email Configuration  
Email Enabled  
Specify whether the user is to be informed about system statuses by  
email.  
Mail Format  
Depending on the selected email format, you can make a number of  
settings in the Email Alerting - Mail Format dependent Configuration group  
(see page 261).  
The following email formats are available:  
Standard  
Fixed Subject  
ITS-Format  
Fujitsu REMCS Format  
270  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Management  
Preferred Mail Server  
Select the preferred mail server.  
You can choose one of the following options:  
Automatic  
If the email cannot be sent successfully immediately, for instance  
because the preferred mail server is not available, the email is sent to  
the second mail server.  
Primary  
Only the mail server which has been configured as the primary SMTP  
server (see page 259) is used as the preferred mail server.  
Secondary  
Only the mail server which has been configured as the secondary  
SMTP server (see page 260) is used as the preferred mail server.  
I
Errors sending email are recorded in the event log.  
Email Address  
Email address of recipient.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
271  
User Management  
Paging Severity Configuration  
Here you can configure system events about which an iRMC S2/S3 user  
is to be informed by email.  
I
Every entry in the event log for the iRMC S2/S3 is assigned to a  
particular paging group.  
The following settings are available for each event group:  
None  
The notification function is deactivated for this paging group.  
Critical  
The iRMC S2/S3 notifies users by email if an entry in the system  
event log is reported as CRITICAL.  
Warning  
The iRMC S2/S3 notifies users by email if an entry in the system  
event log is reported as Minor or Major or Critical.  
All  
The iRMC S2/S3 notifies users of every event in this group which  
causes an entry to be made in the system event log.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
272  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management  
7.14.2 Directory Service Configuration (LDAP) -  
Configuring the directory service at the  
iRMC S2/S3  
In order to perform global user management via a directory service (see the  
"User Management in ServerView" manual), you must configure the  
iRMC S2/S3 appropriately in the Directory Service Configuration page.  
I
Currently, support for iRMC S2/S3 LDAP access is provided for the  
following directory services: Microsoft Active Directory, Novell eDirectory  
I and Open LDAP.  
The following characters are reserved as metacharacters for search  
strings in LDAP: *, \ , &, |, !, =, <, >, ~, :  
You must therefore not use these characters as components of Relative  
Distinguished Names (RDN).  
Figure 157: Directory Service Configuration page (LDAP configuration)  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
273  
 
User Management  
LDAP Enabled  
This option specifies whether the iRMC S2/S3 can access a directory  
service via LDAP. Directory service access via LDAP is only possible if  
LDAP Enable has been activated.  
If LDAP Enable is checked then the login information (see  
page 136) is always transferred with SSL encryption between the  
web browser and the iRMC S2/S3.  
LDAP SSL Enabled  
If you check this option then data transfer between iRMC S2/S3 and the  
directory server is SSL encrypted.  
I
LDAP SSL Enable has no influence on whether or not the  
I iRMC S2/S3 web interface pages are SSL-protected on opening.  
You should only activate LDAP SSL Enable if a domain controller  
certificate is installed.  
Disable Local Login  
If you activate this option then all the local iRMC S2/S3 user  
identifications are locked and only the user identifications managed by  
the directory service are valid.  
V
CAUTION!  
If the option Disable Local Login is activated and the connection to  
the directory service fails then it is no longer possible to log in at  
the iRMC S2/S3.  
AlwaysIuse SSL Login  
This option is only relevant if LDAP is deactivated.  
If you activate this option then the HTTP SSL-secured login page is  
always used even if LDAP is deactivated. Only if you do not activate  
Always use SSL Login and LDAP is deactivated is a mask secured via  
Digest Authentication Login used.  
274  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
User Management  
Directory Server Type  
Type of directory server used:  
The following directory services are supported:  
Active Directory: Microsoft Active Directory  
Novell: Novell eDirectory  
OpenLDAP: OpenLDAP  
Open DS  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Different input fields are provided, depending on the directory service you  
select:  
For Active Directory, refer to section "Configuring iRMC S2/S3 for  
For eDirectory, Open LDAP and OpenDS, refer to section "Configuring  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
275  
User Management  
7.14.2.1 Configuring iRMC S2/S3 for Microsoft Active Directory  
After you have confirmed the Active Directory you have chosen by clicking Apply,  
the following variant of the Directory Service Configuration page is shown:  
Figure 158: Directory Service Configuration: Specifications for Microsoft Active Directory  
I
The entries shown as examples in figure 158 refer to the examples and  
figures shown in the "User Management in ServerView" manual.  
276  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
User Management  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Complete your specifications in the Global Directory Service Configuration  
group:  
Figure 159: Global Directory Service Configuration: Specifications for Microsoft Active  
Directory  
Primary LDAP Server  
LDAP directory server that is to be used.  
LDAP Server  
IP address or DSN name of the primary LDAP server.  
LDAP Port  
LDAP port of the primary LDAP server.  
LDAP SSL Port  
Secure LDAP port of the primary LDAP server  
Backup LDAP Server  
LDAP directory server which is maintained as the backup server and  
used as the directory server if LDAP Server 1 fails.  
LDAP Server  
IP address or DSN name of the Backup LDAP server.  
LDAP Port  
LDAP port of the Backup LDAP server.  
LDAP SSL Port  
Secure LDAP port of the Backup LDAP server  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
277  
User Management  
Domain Name  
Complete DNS path name of the directory server.  
Base DN  
Base DN is automatically derived from Domain Name.  
Groups directory as sub-tree from base DN  
Pathname of the organizational unit (OU) which as a subtree of  
Base DN (Group DN Context) contains the OUs SVS or iRMCgroups.  
Department name  
The department name is used in the directory service in order to  
determine the user permissions and alert roles. A user may have  
different permissions for the department X server than for the  
department Y server.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Ê
Configure the LDAP access data in the Directory Service Access Configuration  
group:  
I
The settings that you make here are required for alerting in  
connection with global user identifications. If alerting is not enabled,  
the settings in the Directory Service Access Configuration group are not  
significant.  
Figure 160: Microsoft Active Directory: Directory Service Access Configuration  
LDAP Auth User Name  
User name the iRMC S2/S3 uses to log onto the LDAP server.  
LDAP Auth Password  
Password the user specified under User Name uses to authenticate  
themselves on the LDAP server.  
Confirm Password  
Repeat the password you entered under LDAP Auth Password.  
278  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management  
Test LDAP Access  
Checks the access data to the LDAP directory server and shows the  
LDAP status as the result (see figure 161).  
I
This test only checks the basic access data (“Is the LDAP  
server present?”, “Is the user configured?”), but does not fully  
authenticate the user.  
Figure 161: Microsoft Active Directory: Status of the connection to the LDAP  
server  
Ê
Click Reset LDAP Status to reset the status display.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Ê
Configure the settings for global email alerting in the Directory Service Email  
Alert Configuration group.  
Figure 162: Directory Service Email Alert Configuration  
LDAP Email Alert Enable  
Enables global email alerting.  
LDAP Alert Table Refresh [Hours]  
Defines the interval at which the email table is regularly updated (see  
the "User Management in ServerView" manual).  
I
It is strongly recommended that you specify a value >0. A  
value of “0” means that the table is not updated regularly.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
279  
 
User Management  
7.14.2.2 Configuring iRMC S2/S3 for Novell eDirectory / OpenLDAP /  
OpenDS  
After you have confirmed you choice of Novell or OpenLDAP by clicking Apply,  
the following variant of the Directory Service Configuration page is shown.  
I
The Directory Service Configuration page has an identical structure for  
Novell eDirectory, OpenLDAP and OpenDS.  
Figure 163: Global Directory Service Configuration: Specifications for Novell eDirectory /  
Open LDAP  
I
The entries shown as examples in figure 163 refer to the examples and  
figures shown in the "User Management in ServerView" manual.  
280  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
User Management  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Complete your specifications in the Global Directory Service Configuration  
group:  
Figure 164: Global Directory Service Configuration: Specifications for Novell eDirectory  
/ Open LDAP / OpenDS  
Primary LDAP Server  
LDAP directory server that is to be used.  
LDAP Server  
IP address or DSN name of the primary LDAP server.  
LDAP Port  
LDAP port of the primary LDAP server.  
LDAP SSL Port  
Secure LDAP port of the primary LDAP server  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
281  
User Management  
Backup LDAP Server  
LDAP directory server which is maintained as the backup server and  
used as the directory server if LDAP Server 1 fails.  
LDAP Server  
IP address or DSN name of the Backup LDAP server.  
LDAP Port  
LDAP port of the Backup LDAP server.  
LDAP SSL Port  
Secure LDAP port of the Backup LDAP server  
Department Name  
Department name. The directory service needs the department  
name in order to determine the user permissions. A user may have  
different permissions for the department X server than for the  
department Y server.  
Base DN  
The Base DN is the fully distinguished name of the eDirectory or Open  
LDAP server and represents the tree or subtree that contains the OU  
(Organizational Unit) SVS or iRMCgroups. This DN forms the starting  
point for LDAP searches.  
Groups directory as sub-tree from base DN  
Pathname of the OU which as a subtree of Base DN  
(Group DN Context) contains the OUs SVS or iRMCgroups.  
User Search Context  
Pathname of the OU which as a subtree of Base DN (User Search  
Context) contains the OU unit Users.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
282  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management  
Ê
Configure the LDAP access data in the Directory Service Access Configuration  
group:  
Figure 165: Novell eDirectory / Open LDAP: Directory Service Access Configuration  
LDAP Auth Password  
Password the Principal User uses to authenticate themselves on the  
LDAP server.  
Confirm Password  
Repeat the password you entered under LDAP Auth Password.  
Principal User DN  
Fully distinguished name, i.e. the full description of the object path  
and attributes of the generic iRMC S2/S3 user ID (principal user),  
under which the iRMC S2/S3 queries the permissions of the  
iRMC S2/S3 users from the LDAP server.  
Append Base DN to Principal User DN  
If you activate this option, you do not need to specify the Base DN  
under Principal User DN. In this event, the Base DN is used that you  
specified under Base DN in the Global Directory Service Configuration  
group.  
Bind DN  
Bind DN shows the principal user DN used for LDAP authentication.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
283  
User Management  
Enhanced User Login  
Enhanced flexibility when users log in.  
V
CAUTION!  
Only activate this option if you are familiar with the LDAP  
syntax. If you inadvertently specify and activate an invalid  
search filter, users can only log in to the iRMC S2/S3 under a  
global login after the Enhanced User Login option has been  
deactivated.  
Figure 166: Enhanced User Login  
If you select Enhanced User Login and activate it with Apply, an  
additional field User Login Search Filter appears containing the  
standard login search filter "(&(objectclass=person)(cn=%s))".  
Figure 167: LDAP search filter for “Enhanced User Login”  
At login, the placeholder “%s” is replaced by the associated global  
login. You can modify the standard filter by specifying another  
attribute in place of “cn=”. All global logins are then permitted to log  
into the iRMC S2/S3 which meet the criteria of this search filter.  
284  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management  
Test LDAP Access  
Checks the access data to the LDAP directory server and shows the  
LDAP status as the result (see figure 161).  
I
This test only checks the basic access data (“Is the LDAP  
server present?”, “Is the user configured?”), but does not fully  
authenticate the user.  
Figure 168: eDirectory / OpenLDAP: Status of the connection to the LDAP server  
Ê
Click Reset LDAP Status to reset the status display.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Ê
Configure the settings for global email alerting in the Directory Service Email  
Alert Configuration group.  
Figure 169: Directory Service Email Alert Configuration  
LDAP Email Alert Enable  
Enables global email alerting.  
LDAP Alert Table Refresh [Hours]  
Defines the interval at which the email table is regularly updated (see  
the "User Management in ServerView" manual). A value of “0” means  
that the table is not updated regularly.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
285  
User Management  
7.14.3 Centralized Authentication Service (CAS)  
Configuration - Configuring the CAS Service  
I
This view is not supported by all PRIMERGY servers with iRMC S2/S3.  
SSO is only supported for accessing the iRMC S2/S3 via the web  
interface. SSO is not supported for accessing the iRMC S2/S3 via the  
Remote Manager (Telnet/SSH).  
The Centralized Authentication Service (CAS) Configuration page allows you to  
configure the iRMC S2/S3 web interface for CAS-based single sign-on (SSO)  
authentication.  
The first time a user logs in to an application within the SSO domain of the CAS  
service, they are prompted for their credentials by the CAS-specific login  
screen. Once they have been successfully authenticated by the CAS service,  
the user is granted access to the iRMC S2/S3 web interface as well as to any  
other service within the SSO domain without being prompted for login  
credentials again.  
Figure 170: Centralized Authentication Service (CAS) Configuration  
286  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Management  
CAS Generic Configuration  
The CAS Generic Configuration group allows you to configure CAS access data.  
Figure 171: CAS Generic Configuration  
CAS Enabled  
Enables SSO using the CAS service that you specify in the  
CAS Generic Configuration group.  
Enable SSL/HTTPS  
All communication between the CAS service and the iRMC S2/S3 is SSL  
encrypted.  
Verify SSL Certifikate  
The SSL Certificate of the CAS service is checked against the CA  
Certificate.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
287  
User Management  
AlwaysIDisplay Login Page  
If Always Display Login Page is disabled and the CAS service  
cannot be reached, type /loginafter the IP address of the  
iRMC S2/S3 in your browser’s navigation bar.  
Always displays the iRMC S2/S3 login page:  
Figure 172: Login page  
Figure 173: Login page - explicit authentication required  
This allows users to temporarily login at the iRMC S2/S3 with privileges  
and permissions that differ from the authorization profile defined under  
CAS User Privilege and Permissions (see page 290).  
A user may, for instance, currently be logged in to the CAS service under  
a user ID with the User privilege and now wants to perform an action  
requiring the Administrator privilege. The user can temporarily login at the  
iRMC S2/S3 under a user ID with the required privileges. However, the  
user cannot switch between both user IDs.  
The buttons iRMC Login and CAS Login work as follows:  
iRMC S2/S3 Login  
Logs the user in to the iRMC S2/S3 web interface with the values  
specified for User name and Password. The CAS service is  
bypassed.  
288  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management  
CAS Login  
Logs the user in to the iRMC S2/S3 web interface via SSO:  
If the user has not been authenticated by the CAS service yet:  
The user is redirected to the CAS service for authentication  
with the specified values for User name and Password.  
If the user has already been authenticated by the CAS service:  
The user is logged in at the iRMC S2/S3 without being  
prompted for username and password.  
CAS Network Port  
Port of the CAS service.  
Default port number: 3170  
CAS Server  
DNS name of the CAS service.  
I
It is absolutely necessary that all systems participating in the SSO  
domain reference the Central Management Station (CMS) via the  
same addressing representation. (An SSO Domain comprises all  
systems where authentication is performed using the same CAS  
service.) Thus, for example, if you have installed the ServerView  
Operations Manager by using the name "my-cms.my-domain",  
you must specify exactly the same name for configuring the CAS  
service for an iRMC S2/S3. If, instead, you specify only "my-cms"  
or another IP address of my-cms, SSO will not be enabled  
between the two systems.  
CAS LoginURL  
Login URL of the CAS service.  
CAS Logout URL  
Logout URL of the CAS service.  
CAS Validate URL  
Validate URL of the CAS service.  
Assign permissions from  
Defines the iRMC S2/S3 privilege and permissions for users who are  
logged in to the iRMC S2/S3 via SSO:  
Local assigned permissions  
The privilege and permissions defined under CAS User Privileg and  
Permissions apply to the user.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
289  
User Management  
Permissions retrieved via LDAP  
The authorization profile defined in the LDAP directory service  
I applies to the user.  
The Permissions retrieved via LDAP option is only available, if LDAP  
is enabled (see option "LDAP Enabled" on page 274).  
CAS User Privilege and Permissions  
The CAS User Privilege and Permissions group allows you to define the  
iRMC S2/S3 privilege and permissions a user is granted if they are logged in at  
the iRMC S2/S3 via SSO.  
I
The CAS User Privilege and Permissions group is not displayed if you have  
selected Permissions retrieved via LDAP under Permissions assigned from in  
the CAS Generic Configuration group.  
Figure 174: CAS User Privilege and Permissions  
Privilege  
Assign a privilege group to the user here:  
User  
Operator  
Administrator  
OEM  
Refer to section "User permissions" on page 68 for information on the  
permissions associated with the privilege groups.  
In addition to the IPMI specific permissions, you can also individually assign  
users the following channel-independent permissions:  
Configure User Accounts  
Permission to configure local user access data.  
290  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Management  
Configure iRMC S2/S3 Settings  
Permission to configure the iRMC S2/S3 settings.  
Video Redirection enabled  
Permission to use Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) in “View Only” and  
“Full Control” mode.  
Remote Storage enabled  
Permission to use the Remote Storage functionality.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
291  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
7.15 Console Redirection - Redirecting the  
console  
The following pages are available for console redirection:  
7.15.1 BIOS Text Console -  
Configure and start text console redirection  
The BIOS Text Console page allows you to configure and start text console  
redirection.  
Text console redirection can also be configured in the BIOS (see section  
Figure 175: BIOS Text Console page  
292  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
7.15.1.1 BIOS Console Redirection Options -  
Configure text console redirection  
BIOS Console Redirection Options allows you to configure text console redirection.  
Figure 176: BIOS Text Console page - BIOS Console Redirection Options  
Console Redirection Enabled  
This option allows you to enable / disable console redirection.  
I
The operating system can also permit text console redirection  
irrespective of the settings in the BIOS.  
Console Redirection Mode  
This setting affects the behavior of console redirection while the  
operating system is running (after the BIOS POST phase has completed)  
Standard  
Console redirection is terminated after the BIOS POST phase.  
Enhanced  
Console redirection continues to be available after the BIOS  
POST phase.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
293  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Console Redirection Port  
Two serial ports are available: Serial 1, Serial 2.  
I
If console redirection is to be performed via LAN, Serial 1 must be  
set.  
If Serial 2 is selected, only the connection over the null modem  
cable works.  
Serial Port Baud Rate  
The following baud rates can be set: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200,  
38400, 57600, 115200.  
Serial Port Flow Control  
The following settings are possible:  
None  
Flow control is disabled.  
XON/XOFF (Software)  
Flow control is handled by the software.  
CTS/RTS (Hardware)  
Flow control is handled by the hardware.  
Terminal Emulation  
The following terminal emulations are available:  
VT100 7Bit, VT100 8Bit, PC-ANSI 7Bit, PC-ANSI 8 Bit, VT100+, VT-UTF8  
Serial 1 Multiplexer  
Check the consistency of the multiplexer settings:  
Serial: System  
LAN: iRMC S2/S3  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
294  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
7.15.1.2 Text Console Redirection (via Serial over LAN) -  
Start text console redirection  
Text Console Redirection (via Serial Over LAN) allows you to start text console  
redirection.  
I
Text console redirection via Serial over LAN (SOL) assumes that the  
operating system and / or the BIOS use serial port 1 (COM1) for text  
console redirection.  
Figure 177: Start text console redirection via Serial over LAN (SOL).  
Ê
Click Start Console Redirection to start text console redirection function.  
The Java applet for text console redirection is started (see figure 178 on  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
295  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Figure 178: Window for power management and text console redirection (before login)  
Ê
Click Logon to log in to the iRMC S2/S3.  
You are then prompted to enter your iRMC S2/S3 user name and  
password:  
Figure 179: Power management and text console redirection - Login window  
296  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Ê
Enter your user name and password and click Login to confirm.  
The window for power management and text console redirection is then  
displayed:  
Console redirection bar Status bar  
Power management bar  
Console area  
Login bar  
Figure 180: Window for power management and text console redirection  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
297  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
The elements of the console redirection window are explained below:  
Login bar  
The login bar shows the IP address and current firmware version of  
the iRMC S2/S3. The Login and Logout buttons allow you to log in to  
and log out of the iRMC S2/S3.  
Power management bar  
The power management bar provides information on the power status  
of the managed server. You can update the display by clicking the  
Status button.  
The Command drop-down list allows you to select and launch an IPMI  
command for power management of the managed server (see page  
page 299). You do not need to be connected with the console to do  
this.  
Console redirection bar  
The Enter Console and Leave Console buttons in the console redirection  
bar allow you to show or hide the display in the console area.  
Console area  
The console area contains the display from the redirected text  
console.  
Status bar  
The status bar shows the IP address of the iRMC S2/S3 and the port  
number used for console redirection. In addition, the status bar  
provides information on the status of the console redirection (online /  
offline).  
298  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Ê
Click Enter Console.  
You are then connected to the console and can execute the required  
command, either by entering it directly in the console area or by clicking it in  
the Command drop-down list (IPMI commands only):  
Enter SAC command directly.  
(No confirmation prompt!)  
or  
Select IPMI command and  
click.  
Figure 181: Entering SAC or IPMI commands at the console.  
IPMI command  
Power On  
Power Off  
Reset  
Explanation  
Switches the server on.  
Switches the server off.  
Completely restarts the server (cold start), regardless of the status of  
the operating system.  
Power Cycle  
Shutdown  
Powers the server down completely and then powers it up again after  
approximately 5 seconds.  
Graceful shutdown and power off.  
Ê
To close the connection to the console, click Leave Console.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
299  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
7.15.1.3 Text console redirection while the operating system is running  
Depending on the operating system used on the managed server, you can  
continue to use console redirection after the BIOS / UEFI POST phase.  
DOS  
I
Condition:  
The BIOS setting for console redirection mode must be set to Enhanced  
If the managed server starts the PRIMERGY ServerView Suite diagnosis  
software, you can operate PRIMERGY ServerView Suite diagnosis using  
console redirection.  
Windows Server 2003 / 2008  
Windows Server 2003 / 2008 handles console redirection automatically after the  
POST phase. No further settings are necessary. While the operating system is  
booting, the Windows Server 2003 SAC console / Windows Server 2008 SAC  
console is transferred:  
Figure 182: Windows Server 2003 SAC console  
Linux  
You must configure a Linux operating system in such a way that it handles  
console redirection after the POST phase. Once it has been configured, you  
have complete remote access.  
300  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Settings required  
The settings may differ between program versions.  
SuSe and RedHat  
Add the following line to the end of the file /etc/inittab:  
xx:12345:respawn:/sbin/agetty <baud-rate> ttyS0  
RedHat  
Insert the following kernel boot parameter in the file /etc/grub.conf:  
console=ttyS0,<baud-rate> console=tty0  
SuSE  
Insert the following kernel boot parameter in the file /boot/grub/menu.lst:  
console=ttyS0,<baud-rate> console=tty0  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
301  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
7.15.2 Advanced Video Redirection -  
Start Advanced Video Redirection (AVR)  
The Advanced Video Redirection page allows you to start graphical console  
redirection. The “Advanced Video Redirection” feature redirects graphical  
output from the managed server to the remote workstation and assigns  
keyboard and mouse input from the remote workstation to the managed server  
so that you can access the managed server from the remote workstation as if  
you were working locally.  
AVR can be used by two users simultaneously. One user has full control over  
the server (full-control mode) and the other can only passively observe  
keyboard and mouse operation of the server (view-only mode).  
I
In order to use the iRMC S2/S3 function Advanced Video Redirection, you  
The AVR functionality is made available with a Java applet.  
302  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Figure 183: Advanced Video Redirection page  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
303  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Creating an ASR screenshot  
The ASR Screenshot page allows you to  
take a screenshot of the current VGA screen on the managed server (video  
screenshot) and store it in the firmware of the iRMC S2/S3,  
view the screenshot stored in the iRMC S2/S3 firmware,  
delete the screenshot stored in the iRMC S2/S3 firmware,  
Figure 184: Creating an video screenshot  
I
A video screenshot is automatically created on ASR&R events - in  
Windows, these are typically watchdog events or "bluescreens" on the  
managed server.  
A maximum of one video screenshot is stored in the firmware of the  
iRMC S2/S3, namely the most recently created screenshot.  
The following actions are available by clicking on one of the buttons displayed:  
View Screenshot  
(This only appears if a video screenshot has been stored.)  
The screenshot is shown in a separate browser window.  
Preview Screenshot  
(This only appears if a video screenshot has been stored.)  
A thumbnail of the screenshot is shown in the ASR Screenshot group.  
Make Screenshot  
Takes a new video screenshot.  
Delete Screenshot  
(This only appears if a video screenshot has been stored.)  
The video screenshot stored in the iRMC S2/S3 firmware is deleted after  
you have confirmed that you wish to do so.  
304  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
AVR Active Session Table - Show current AVR sessions  
The AVR Active Session Table lists the currently active AVR sessions. If no AVR  
session is currently active then the AVR Active Session Table is not displayed.  
If two AVR Sessions are currently active, a Disconnect button is displayed for  
each Session.  
Figure 185: AVR Active Session Table - (two active AVR sessions)  
Disconnect  
If you click Disconnect, a confirmation dialog box appears in which you  
can close the AVR session to the left of the button.  
I
You can only close AVR sessions of other users with the  
Disconnect button. To close your own session, choose Exit from the  
Extras menu in the AVR window (see page 102).  
Video Redirection Options - Deactivating USB ports on the managed  
server for the duration of the AVR session  
I
This function is not supported for all PRIMERGY servers.  
Video Redirection Options - Disable USB Port allows you to specify which USB  
ports are to be disabled on the managed server for the duration of the AVR  
session.  
Figure 186: Video Redirection Options  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
305  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
None  
No USB port will be disabled.  
Front USB  
Only the USB port on the front of the server will be disabled.  
Rear USB  
Only the USB port on the back of the server will be disabled.  
Disable All  
All USB ports of the server will be disabled.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
Local Monitor - Power up / down options for local server monitor  
The status of the local monitor on the managed server is shown under Local  
In addition, you can configure:  
that the local monitor can be switched on and off from the remote  
workstation,  
that the local monitor shuts down automatically for the duration of the AVR  
session when an AVR session is started,  
Figure 187: Advanced Video Redirection page - Local Monitor  
306  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Enable Local Monitor Off  
This option allows you to activate the following options:  
In full-control mode of an AVR session, you can switch the local  
monitor on and off (AVR Extras menu, see page 102).  
For users with administrator or OEM permissions, the toggle  
button Turn Off / Turn On is also enabled. This also allows the local  
monitor to be switched on and off (see figure 188).  
Figure 188: Advanced Video Redirection page - Local Monitor On / Off  
You can also configure that the local monitor is switched off  
automatically for the duration of an AVR session when an AVR  
session is started (see the Automatic Local Monitor Off when AVR is  
started option).  
I
If no concurrent session with Local Monitor Off is active, the local  
monitor is automatically switched on again when the AVR session  
is closed.  
AutomaItic Local Monitor Off when AVR is started  
This option only takes effect if Enable Local Monitor has been  
activated.  
If you activate this option, the local monitor is automatically switched off  
for the duration of the session when an AVR session is started. After the  
AVR session is closed, the local monitor is automatically switched on  
again if no concurrent session with Local Monitor Off is active.  
I
Parallel AVR sessions:  
Even if you switch on the local monitor during your AVR session  
(in the AVR menu Extras or with the Turn On button), the local  
monitor is automatically switched off again if a new, concurrent  
AVR session is started.  
The local monitor is switched on again automatically when all AVR  
sessions have been closed.  
Ê
Click Apply to activate your settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
307  
   
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Video Redirection - Starting AVR  
You start AVR under Video Redirection.  
Figure 189: Advanced Video Redirection page - Local Monitor  
Ê
Click Start Video Redirection or Start Video Redirection (Java Web-Start) to start  
a second AVR session.  
The Java applet for Advanced Video Redirection is started.  
I
The Java applet shows the AVR window in view-only mode if another  
user already uses AVR in full-control mode. Otherwise, the Java  
applet shows the AVR window in full-control mode.  
Figure 190: AVR window (view-only mode)  
308  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
Ê
Select Extras - Take Full Control... in the AVR menu (see page 103 for details),  
to take over full control of the managed server.  
I
If you attempt to take full control of the managed server using AVR,  
an already existing full-control session will be notified. by the following  
dialog:  
If the full-control session refuses your attempt to take full control, your  
session will remain in view-only mode. Users should agree among  
themselves what modes they are to use in their sessions.  
If you succeeded in taking full control, the window for active use of AVR is  
opened, with which you can log into the managed server (see figure 191 on  
Figure 191: AVR window (full-control mode)  
The menus of the AVR window and the integrated special keys are described in  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
309  
 
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
The two active AVR sessions are shown as follows on the Advanced Video  
Redirection page:  
Figure 192: AVR window with two active AVR sessions  
Disconnect  
If you click Disconnect, a confirmation dialog box appears in which you  
can close the AVR session to the left of the button.  
I
You can only close AVR sessions of other users with the  
Disconnect button. To close your own session, choose Exit from the  
Extras menu in the AVR window (see page 102).  
310  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Console Redirection - Redirecting the console  
The following window appears if the managed server is powered down:  
Figure 193: AVR window when the server is powered down  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
311  
Remote Storage  
7.16 Remote Storage  
The Remote Storage feature provides the managed server with a “virtual” drive  
which is physically located elsewhere in the network. The source for the virtual  
drive can be a physical drive (floppy disk drive CD-ROM/DVD-ROM) or an ISO  
image (image file).  
I
In order to use the iRMC S2/S3 function Remote Storage, you require a  
license key (see page 167).  
You can make the remote storage media available as follows:  
As a physical drive or image file at the remote workstation (see page 113).  
The image file may also be a network drive (with drive letter, e.g. “D:” for  
drive D).  
As an image file centrally in the network via a remote storage server (see  
I
Parallel remote storage connections:  
The following are possible concurrently:  
either up to two Remote Storage connections to virtual drives at the  
remote workstation (if the connection is established over the AVR  
Java applet) or  
one Remote Storage connection to a Remote Storage server.  
Remote storage connections via applet and Remote Storage Server are  
not possible simultaneously.  
The Remote Storage page allows you to display information on the status of the  
current remote storage connections and establish the connection to a remote  
storage server.  
312  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Remote Storage  
Figure 194: Remote Storage page  
Remote Storage Connection Status  
Displays the status of the remote storage connection:  
No  
Displays the sequential number of the remote storage device.  
IP Address  
Displays the IP address of the server or workstation on which the remote  
storage device is installed.  
Share Index  
Displays the number assigned to the remote storage connection.  
Share Origin  
Displays the status of the remote storage device on a server or on a  
remote workstation:  
Applet: Connectable  
None: Not connectable (Not found)  
iRMC S2/S3  
313  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Storage  
Share Status  
Displays the current status of the connection:  
Connected: Connected  
Idle: Not connected  
Remote Storage Server  
Allows you to specify a computer on which a remote storage server is installed.  
No  
Displays the sequential number of the remote storage server.  
IP Address or DNS Name  
Specifies the IP address or the registered DNS name of the computer on  
which a remote storage server is installed.  
Apply  
Click Apply to save the remote storage server’s IP address or DNS name.  
Connect  
Click Apply to save the remote storage server’s IP address or DNS name  
and establish the connection to the remote storage server.  
I
Before it is possible to establish the connection to the remote  
storage server the remote storage server must be installed and  
running.  
Disconnect  
Click Disconnect to terminate the connection to the remote storage server.  
314  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet / SSH (Remote Manager)  
7.17 Operating iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet / SSH  
(Remote Manager)  
A Telnet / SSH-based interface is available for the iRMC S2/S3. This is known  
as the Remote Manager. The alphanumeric user interface of the Remote  
Manager provides you with access to system and sensor information, power  
management functions and the error event log. You can also start text console  
redirection and a SMASH CLP shell.  
You can call the Remote Manager from the iRMC S2/S3 web interface as  
follows:  
Use the iRMC S2/S3 SSH Access link to initiate an SSH (Secure Shell)  
encrypted Telnet connection to the iRMC S2/S3.  
Use the iRMC S2/S3 Telnet Access link to initiate an unencrypted Telnet  
connection to the iRMC S2/S3.  
Calling the Remote Manager from the iRMC S2/S3 web interface automatically  
starts a Java applet, which implements a Telnet / SSH client. Telnet / SSH  
access to Remote Manager using the Java applet is provided for convenience  
(e.g. no SSH client is supplied together with Windows operating systems).  
However, to access the Remote Manager, you can use any Telnet or SSH  
Client.  
I
If you establish an SSH connection using the Java applet, public key  
I authentication is not supported.  
Maximum number of parallel sessions:  
Telnet: up to 4  
SSH: up to 4  
Telnet and SSH in total: up to 4  
Operation of the iRMC S2/S3 using the Remote Manager is described in  
Requirements on the managed server  
Access via Telnet must be activated for the iRMC S2/S3 (see the section "Ports  
I
Access via the Telnet protocol is deactivated by default for security  
reasons, as passwords are transmitted in plain text.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
315  
   
Operating iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet / SSH (Remote Manager)  
Establishing an SSH / Telnet connection and logging into the  
Remote Manager  
I
If the screen displays for SSH and Telnet connections differ only with  
respect to the connection-specific information displayed, the display for  
an SSH connection is shown below.  
Ê
In the navigation bar, click on the link iRMC S2/S3 SSH Access (SSH) or iRMC  
S2/S3 Telnet Access (Telnet).  
The Java applet for the SSH or Telnet connection is started and the following  
window is displayed (in this case using the example of an SSH connection):  
Figure 195: Establishing an SSH connection to the iRMC S2/S3  
316  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet / SSH (Remote Manager)  
Ê
In the connection bar, click Connect.  
As soon as the connection to the iRMC S2/S3 has been established, you are  
requested to enter the user name and password.  
Logging into the Remote Manager over an SSH connection  
I
If the host key of the managed server is not yet registered at the  
remote workstation, the SSH client issues a security alert with  
suggestions on how to proceed.  
The following login window is displayed:  
Figure 196: SSH connection: Logging in to the Remote Manager  
Ê
Enter your user name and password and confirm your entries by  
clicking Login.  
The main menu of the Remote Manager is then displayed (see  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
317  
Operating iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet / SSH (Remote Manager)  
Logging into the Remote Manager over a Telnet connection  
The Remote Manager login window is displayed:  
Figure 197: Telnet connection: Logging in to the Remote Manager  
I
Depending on whether ServerView agents have already been  
started at some point on the system, the login window is shown  
with or without system information (see page 326).  
Ê
Enter your user name and password and confirm your entries by  
pressing [Enter].  
The main menu of the Remote Manager is then displayed (see  
318  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet / SSH (Remote Manager)  
Figure 198: Main menu of the Remote Manager  
Closing a Telnet / SSH connection  
Ê
Close the connection to the Remote Manager by clicking the Disconnect  
button in the connection bar of the Remote Manager window or by pressing  
the [0] key in the main menu of the Remote Manager (see figure 198).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
319  
 
Operating iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet / SSH (Remote Manager)  
320  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
iRMC S2/S3 via Telnet/SSH  
(Remote Manager)  
A Telnet-based interface is available for the iRMC S2/S3. This is known as the  
Remote Manager. You can call the Remote Manager over the following  
interfaces:  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface (see page 315)  
any Telnet/SSH client  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports secure connections over SSH (Secure Shell). The  
Remote Manager interface is identical for Telnet and SSH connections. In  
principle, any Telnet/SSH client that interprets VT100 sequences can be used  
to access the iRMC S2/S3. It is nevertheless recommended that the  
iRMC S2/S3 web interface or the ServerView Remote Management Frontend  
(referred to below simply as the Remote Management Frontend) be used.  
I
Maximum number of parallel sessions:  
Telnet: up to 4  
SSH: up to 4  
Telnet and SSH in total: up to 4  
This chapter describes operation of the iRMC S2/S3 from the Remote Manager  
and the various functions in detail. The end of the chapter also provides a brief  
overview of SMASH CLP.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
321  
   
Requirements on the managed server  
8.1  
Requirements on the managed server  
Access via Telnet must be activated for the iRMC S2/S3 (see the section "Ports  
I
Access via the Telnet protocol is deactivated by default for security  
I reasons, as passwords are transmitted in plain text.  
Since the ServerView Operations Manager does not know the value of  
the management port, the Remote Management Frontend works with the  
default value.  
Since a connection is not automatically established when the Remote  
Management Frontend is started, you can correct any nonstandard value  
for the management port after the Remote Management Frontend has  
been started.  
322  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating Remote Manager  
8.2  
Operating Remote Manager  
Operation of Remote view is described on the basis of the example in  
figure 199, which shows an excerpt from the main menu of the Remote  
Manager.  
Figure 199: Operating the Remote Manager  
Ê
Select the required menu item by entering the number or letter which  
precedes the menu item, e.g. “c” for “Change password”.  
Functions that the user is not permitted to use are indicated by a dash (-)  
and functions that are not available are indicated by an asterisk (*).  
Ê
Press [0] or the key combination [Ctrl] [D] to close the Remote Manager. An  
appropriate event will be written to the event log.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
323  
   
Overview of menus  
8.3  
Overview of menus  
The Remote Manager menu for the iRMC S2/S3 has the following structure:  
System Information  
View Chassis Information  
View Mainboard Information  
View OS and SNMP Information  
Set ASSET Tag  
Power Management  
Immediate Power Off  
Immediate Reset  
Power Cycle  
Power on  
Graceful Power Off (Shutdown)  
Graceful Reset (Reboot)  
Raise NMI (via iRMC S2/S3)  
Enclosure Information  
System Eventlog  
View System Eventlog (text, newest first)  
View System Eventlog (text, oldest first)  
Dump System Eventlog (raw, newest first)  
Dump System Eventlog (raw, oldest first)  
View System Eventlog Information  
Clear System Eventlog  
324  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overview of menus  
Internal Eventlog  
View Internal Eventlog (text, newest last)  
Dump Internal Eventlog (raw, newest last)  
View Internal Eventlog Information  
Clear Internal Eventlog  
Change Internal Eventlog mode  
Temperature  
Voltages/Current  
Fans  
Power Supplies  
Memory Sensor  
Door Lock  
CPU Sensors  
Component Status (Lightpath)  
List All Sensors  
Service Processor  
Configure IP Parameters  
List IP Parameters  
Toggle Identify LED  
Reset iRMC S2/S3 (Warm reset)  
Reset iRMC S2/S3 (Cold reset)  
Change password  
Console Redirection (EMS/SAC)  
Start a Command Line shell  
Console Logging  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
325  
Logging in  
8.4  
Logging in  
When connecting to the iRMC S2/S3, you are required to enter your login  
credentials (username and password). As soon as a connection to the  
iRMC S2/S3 has been established, the main menu window of the Remote  
Manager (Telnet/SSH window) is displayed at the terminal client at the remote  
workstation.  
Depending on whether ServerView agents have already been started at some  
point on the system, the main window is shown with or without system  
information.  
I
When logging in over an SSH connection: If the host key of the managed  
server is not yet registered at the remote workstation, the SSH client  
issues a security alert with suggestions on how to proceed.  
Figure 200: Remote Manager: Main menu window (with system information)  
326  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Logging in  
Figure 201: Remote Manager: Main menu window (without system information)  
The Remote Manager window contains information on the affected system. This  
information identifies the server and indicates its operating status (Power  
Status). Some details (e.g. the System Name) are only shown for servers and  
only if the server is configured appropriately.  
Ê
In order to be able to use the Remote Manager, you must log in with a user  
name and a password.  
Then an appropriate event will be written to the Event log and the relevant  
main menu of the Remote Manager displayed (see section "Main menu of  
You can terminate the login process at any time using [Ctrl][D].  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
327  
Main menu of the Remote Manager  
8.5  
Main menu of the Remote Manager  
Figure 202: Remote Manager: Main menu  
The main menu of the Remote Manager provides the following functions:  
System Information...  
View information on the managed  
server and set the Asset Tag  
Power Management...  
Power the server up or down.  
Enclosure Information...  
Request information on the current  
system status, e.g. check error and  
event messages from the error log  
and event log (temperature, fan, etc.)  
Table 8: Main menu of the Remote Manager  
328  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Main menu of the Remote Manager  
Service Processor...  
Configure the iRMC S2/S3iRMC  
S2/S3 (e.g. update firmware or  
change IP address)  
Change password  
Change the password  
Console Redirection (EMS/SAC)  
Text console redirection  
Start a Command Line shell...  
Start a command line shell  
Console Logging  
Redirect output of messages to the  
text console  
Table 8: Main menu of the Remote Manager  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
329  
Required user permissions  
8.6  
Required user permissions  
In table 9 is given an overview of the user permissions which are required in  
order to use the individual Remote Manager functions.  
Remote Manager menu items  
Permitted with  
IPMI privilege  
level  
Required  
permission  
View System Information...  
X
X
X
X
View Chassis / M ainboard, / OS Information  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1)  
Set ASSET Tag  
1)  
Set System Name  
1)  
Set System Operating System Information  
1)  
Set System Description  
1)  
Set System Location Information (SNMP)  
1)  
Set System Contact Information (SNMP)  
Power Management...  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
View Enclosure Information  
X
X
System Eventlog - View/Dump System Eventlog  
System Eventlog - Clear System Eventlog  
Internal Eventlog - View/Dump Internal Eventlog  
Internal Eventlog - Clear Internal Eventlog  
Sensor overviews (Temperature, Fans ...)  
View Service Processor...  
X
X
X
X
Service Processor... - List IP Parameters  
X
Table 9: Permissions to use the Remote Manager menus  
330  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Required user permissions  
Remote Manager menu items  
Permitted with  
IPMI privilege  
level  
Required  
permission  
Service Processor... - Configure IP Parameters  
Service Processor... - Toggle Identify LED  
Service Proc. ... - Reset iRMC S2/S3 (warm/cold reset)  
Change Password  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Console Redirection (EMS/SAC)  
Start a command Line shell...  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Console Logging  
1)  
Action is only possible if no agents are running.  
Table 9: Permissions to use the Remote Manager menus  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
331  
Change the password  
8.7  
Change the password  
The Change password menu item allows a user with the privilege Configure User  
Accounts (see page 68) to change their own password or the passwords of other  
users.  
8.8  
System Information -  
Information on the managed server  
The following menu appears if you choose System Information... from the main  
menu:  
Figure 203: Remote Manager: System Information menu  
The submenu contains the following functions:  
View Chassis Information  
Information on the chassis of the managed  
server and its product data.  
View Mainboard Information  
Information on the mainboard of the managed  
server and its product data.  
View OS and SNMP Information Information on the operating system and the  
ServerView version of the managed server and  
on the SNMP settings.  
Table 10: System Information menu  
332  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Information - Information on the managed server  
Set ASSET Tag  
Sets a customer-specific asset tag for the  
managed server.  
Table 10: System Information menu  
iRMC S2/S3  
333  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Management  
8.9  
Power Management  
The following menu appears if you choose Power Management... from the main  
menu:  
Figure 204: Remote Manager: Power Management menu  
The submenu contains the following functions:  
Immediate Power Off  
Immediate Reset  
Power Cycle  
Powers the server down, regardless of the status of  
the operating system.  
Completely restarts the server (cold start),  
regardless of the status of the operating system.  
Powers the server down completely and then  
powers it up again after a configured period.  
Power On  
Switches the server on.  
Graceful Power Off  
(Shutdown)  
Graceful shutdown and power off.  
This menu item is only available if ServerView  
agents are installed and signed onto the  
iRMC S2/S3 as “Connected”.  
Graceful Reset (Reboot) Graceful shutdown and reboot.  
This menu item is only available if ServerView  
agents are installed and signed onto the  
iRMC S2/S3 as “Connected”.  
Raise NMI  
(via iRMC S2/S3)  
Initiates a non-maskable interrupt (NMI) via  
iRMC S2/S3  
Table 11: Power Management menu  
334  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Enclosure Information  
8.10 Enclosure Information -  
System event log and status of the sensors  
The following menu appears if you choose Enclosure Information... from the main  
menu:  
Figure 205: Remote Manager: Enclosure Information menu  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
335  
 
Enclosure Information  
The submenu contains the following functions:  
System Eventlog  
Internal Eventlog  
Temperature  
Call the System Eventlog menu (see the section "System  
Call the internal Eventlog menu (see the section  
Display information on the temperature sensors and  
their status.  
Voltages/Current  
Display information on the voltage and current sensors  
and their status.  
Fans  
Display information on the fans and their status.  
Power Supplies  
Display information on the power supplies and their  
redundancy status.  
Door Lock  
Display information on whether the front panel or  
housing are open.  
Memory Sensors  
CPU Sensors  
Display information on the memory statuses.  
Localize the processors of the server.  
Component Status  
Display detailed information on all sensors that have a  
PRIMERGY diagnostic LED.  
List All Sensors  
Display detailed information on all sensors.  
Table 12: Enclosure Information menu  
336  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enclosure Information  
System Eventlog  
The following menu appears if you select System Eventlog from the Enclosure  
Information... submenu:  
Figure 206: Remote Manager: System Eventlog menu  
The submenu contains the following functions:  
View System Eventlog The contents of the System Event log are output to  
(text, newest first)  
screen in a readable form and in chronological order  
(the most recent entry first).  
View System Eventlog The contents of the System Event log are output to  
(text, oldest first)  
screen in a readable form and in reverse chronological  
order (the oldest entry first).  
Dump System Eventlog The contents of the System Event log are dumped in  
(raw, newest first) chronological order (the most recent entry first).  
Dump System Eventlog The contents of the System Event log are dumped in  
(raw, oldest first) reverse chronological order (the oldest entry first).  
View System Eventlog Display information on the System Event log.  
Information  
Clear System Eventlog Clear the contents of the System Event log.  
Change System  
Eventlog mode  
Changes the buffer mode of the System Event Log  
from Ring Buffer mode to Linear Buffer mode and vice  
versa.  
Table 13: System Eventlog menu  
iRMC S2/S3  
337  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Enclosure Information  
Internal Eventlog  
The following menu appears if you select Internal Eventlog from the Enclosure  
Information... submenu:  
Figure 207: Remote Manager: Internal Eventlog menu  
The submenu contains the following functions:  
View Internal Eventlog The contents of the internal event log are output to  
(text, newest last)  
screen in a readable form and in reverse chronological  
order (the most recent entry last).  
Dump Internal  
The contents of the internal event log are dumped in  
Eventlog (raw, newest reverse chronological order (the most recent entry  
last ) last).  
View Internal Eventlog Display information on the internal event log.  
Information  
Clear Internal Eventlog Clear the contents of the internal event log.  
Change Internal  
Eventlog mode  
Changes the buffer mode of the internal event log from  
Ring Buffer mode to Linear Buffer mode and vice versa.  
Table 14: Internal Eventlog menu  
338  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service Processor  
8.11 Service processor - IP parameters,  
identification LED and iRMC S2/S3 reset  
The following menu appears if you choose Service Processor... from the main  
menu:  
Figure 208: Remote Manager: Service Processor menu  
The submenu contains the following functions:  
Configure IP Parameters Configure the IPv4 / IPv6 address settings of the  
iRMC S2/S3 in a guided dialog. Please refer to  
for details in the individual settings.  
List IP Parameters  
Toggle Identify LED  
Display the IP settings.  
Switch the PRIMERGY identification LED on/off.  
Reset iRMC S2/S3  
(Warm reset)  
Reset the iRMC S2/S3. The connection is closed.  
Only the interfaces are re-initialized.  
Reset iRMC S2/S3  
(Cold reset)  
Reset the iRMC S2/S3. The connection is closed.  
The entire iRMC S2/S3 is re-initialized.  
Table 15: Service Processor menu  
I
It is recommended that you reboot the server after a Reset iRMC S2/S3  
(Cold Reset) or Reset iRMC S2/S3 (Warm Reset) (see page 189).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
339  
   
Console Redirection (EMS/SAC)  
8.12 Console Redirection (EMS/SAC) -  
Start text console redirection  
You can start console redirection with the Console Redirection (EMS/SAC) item  
from the main menu.  
I
Text-based console redirection only works over the LAN with Serial 1.  
If console redirection is also to be used while the operating system is  
I running, the Serial 1 Multiplexer must be set to System.  
Use the keyboard shortcut "<ESC>(" or "~." (tilde dot) to exit the text  
console.  
It is possible that only one of these options will work, depending on the  
type of PRIMERGY server used.  
8.13 Start a Command Line shell... -  
Start a SMASH CLP shell  
Start a Command Line shell... in the main menu allows you to start a SMASH CLP  
shell. SMASH CLP stands for “Systems Management Architecture for Server  
Hardware Command Line Protocol”. This protocol permits a Telnet- or SSH-  
based connection between the management station and the managed server.  
For further details on SMASH CLP, please refer to section "Command Line  
When you select (s) Start a Command Line shell... from the main menu, the  
following window appears:  
Figure 209: Remote Manager: Start a SMASH CLP shell... menu  
Ê
Choose (1) Start a SMASH CLP shell... to start the SMASH CLP shell.  
340  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Console Logging  
8.14 Console Logging - Redirect message  
output to the text console (serial)  
The Console Logging item in the main menu allows you to redirect message  
output (logging) to the text console (serial interface).  
When you select (l) Console Logging from the main menu, the following window  
appears:  
Figure 210: Remote Manager: Console Logging menu  
The submenu contains the following functions:  
Change Logging Run state  
Show and change the logging run state.  
For a more detailed description, see  
Clear Console Logging buffer  
Replay Console (Fast mode)  
Clear the console logging buffer.  
Show the console log (in fast mode)  
Replay Console (Continuous mode) Show the console log  
(in continuous mode)  
Table 16: Console Logging menu  
iRMC S2/S3  
341  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Console Logging  
Console Logging Run State Menu  
Figure 211: Remote Manager: Console Logging Run State menu  
The Console Logging Run State Menu provides the following functions:  
Start Console Logging Start output of messages to the text console.  
Stop Console Logging Stop output of messages to the text console.  
Toggle to Text Mode  
Switch to text mode.  
All escape sequences are filtered out before messages  
are output to the console.  
Toggle to Normal Mode Switch to normal mode.  
In normal mode, only the following escape sequences  
are filtered out before messages are output to the  
console:  
<ESC>(  
<ESC>stop  
<ESC>Q  
<ESC>R<ESC>r<ESC>R  
<ESC>^  
This means that color, pseudo-graphics, etc. can also  
be represented to a limited extent.  
Table 17: Console Logging Run State menu  
342  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Command Line Protocol (CLP)  
8.15 Command Line Protocol (CLP)  
The iRMC S2/S3 supports various text-based user interfaces, known as user  
shells, which can be configured differently for individual users.  
The System Management Architecture for Server Hardware (SMASH) initiative  
defines a number of specifications with the following objectives:  
Provision of standardized interfaces for managing heterogeneous computer  
environments,  
Provision of an architecture framework with uniform interfaces, hardware  
and software discovery, resource addressing and data models.  
You can find further information on SMASH under the following link:  
http://www.dmtf.org/standards/smash  
SMASH CLP syntax  
SMASH CLP specifies a common command line syntax and message protocol  
semantics for managing computers on the Internet and in enterprise and  
service provider environments. You can find detailed information on SMASH  
CLP in the DMTF document “Server Management Command Line Protocol  
Specification (SM CLP) DSP0214”.  
The general syntax of the CLP is as follows:  
<verb> [<options>] [<target>] [<properties>]  
<verb>  
Verbs specify the command or action to be executed. The list of verbs  
describes the following activities, for instance:  
Establish (set) and retrieve (show) data,  
Change the status of a target (reset, start, stop),  
Manage the current session (cd, version, exit),  
Return information on commands (help).  
In iRMC S2/S3 systems, the verb oemfujitsu also allows the use of special  
OEM commands.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
343  
 
Command Line Protocol (CLP)  
<options>  
Command options modify the action or the behavior of a verb. Options  
can immediately follow the verb in a command line and must always be  
introduced by a dash ("-").  
Options allow you to, for instance,  
define the output format,  
permit recursive execution of a command,  
display the version of a command or  
request help.  
<target>  
<target> specifies the address or the path of the object to be manipulated  
by the command, i.e. the target of the command. This can be a single  
managed element such as a hard disk, a network adapter (Network  
Interface Card, NIC), or the management program (Management  
Assistance Program, MAP) itself. Targets can, however, also be services  
such as a transport service.  
Several managed elements which can be managed by the management  
program can be subsumed under a single <target>, for instance the  
entire system.  
Only one <target> may be specified for each command.  
<properties>  
<properties> describe the properties of the target of the command which  
are required to execute the command. Thus, <properties> identify the  
properties of the target’s class that are to be retrieved or modified by the  
command.  
344  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Command Line Protocol (CLP)  
User data in the CLP (overview)  
Data within the CLP is structured hierarchically. The command cd allows you to  
navigate within this structure.  
An overview of the user data in the CLP is shown in figure 212. The names in  
rectangles indicate command targets. On every level of the hierarchy, the  
command/verb show displays the available targets, properties and verbs.  
/./root  
system 1  
map 1  
log 1  
firmware  
accounts  
nic 1  
oemsensors  
oemsefru  
record 1  
record n  
user 1  
user 16  
Figure 212: Structure of the user data in SMASH CLP  
Hierarchy of the CLP commands  
An overview of the CLP command hierarchy is shown in table 18 on page 346.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
345  
 
Command Line Protocol (CLP)  
Table 18: Hierarchy of the CLP commands  
346  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9
Configuring iRMC S2/S3 using  
the Server Configuration  
Manager  
You can use the Server Configuration Manager to  
configure the iRMC S2/S3,  
configure and manage user IDs at the iRMC S2/S3,  
configure a directory service on the iRMC S2/S3,  
configure the CAS service on the iRMC S2/S3.  
I
Requirements:  
The current ServerView agents must be installed on the managed server.  
The Server Configuration Manager functions can be accessed in the following  
ways:  
Locally on managed servers using the ServerView Installation Manager.  
Locally on managed Windows-based servers using the Windows Start  
menu.  
I
This is only supported for servers on which the ServerView agents for  
Windows are installed.  
On the remote workstation using the graphical interface of the Operations  
Manager.  
I
This is only supported for servers on which the ServerView agents for  
Windows are installed.  
This chapter in detail describes the various ways to call the Server Configuration  
Manager.  
I
For details on the Configuration Manager dialog pages, please refer to  
the online help of the Server Configuration Manager.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
347  
   
Configuring via Server Configuration Manager  
9.1  
Calling the Server Configuration Manager  
from the ServerView Installation Manager  
You can call the Server Configuration Manager from the ServerView Installation  
Manager (Installation Manager for short). Configuration via the Installation  
Manager is of significance when installing the server. The Installation Manager  
makes the Server Configuration Manager available both during preparation for  
installation and as a separate maintenance program. The Installation Manager  
is described in the manual “ServerView Installation Manager”.  
9.2  
Calling the Server Configuration Manager  
from the Windows Start menu  
On Windows-based servers, you can also call the Server Configuration  
Manager via the Windows Start menu.  
To do this, proceed as follows:  
Ê
On the managed server, select:  
Start – All Programs – Fujitsu – ServerView – Agents – Configuration Tools –  
System Configuration.  
The System Configuration window opens:  
Figure 213: System Configuration window  
348  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring via Server Configuration Manager  
Ê
Ê
Accept the preset values.  
Click OK.  
The tab view of the System Configuration window opens.  
You can scroll to the left and right through the tabs by clicking the arrows next  
to the tabs.  
Applying settings  
To apply the settings made in the individual tabs, proceed as follows for each  
tab:  
Ê
Ê
Click the Apply button.  
Click the Save Page button.  
The iRMC S2/S3 automatically reboots to activate the changed settings.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
349  
Configuring via Server Configuration Manager  
9.3  
alling the Server Configuration Manager  
from the Operations Manager  
The Server Configuration Manager dialog boxes for configuring the iRMC S2/S3  
are also available from the graphical user interface of the Operations Manager.  
This allows you to configure the iRMC S2/S3 of the managed server from the  
remote workstation via a Web interface.  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Start the Operations Manager (refer to the manual “ServerView Operations  
Manager”).  
The start window of the Operations Manager opens:  
Figure 214: Operations Manager: Start window  
350  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring via Server Configuration Manager  
Ê
Choose Server Configuration from the Administration menu of the Operations  
Manager start window.  
This opens the following window:  
Figure 215: Operations Manager: Server Configuration window - Server list (1) tab  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
351  
Configuring via Server Configuration Manager  
Ê
In the hierarchy tree of the Server list tab, select the server to be configured.  
This opens the following window:  
Figure 216: Operations Manager: Server Configuration window - Server list (2) tab  
Ê
In the right-hand side of the window, specify the details on the selected  
server and confirm your entries by clicking GO... .  
The first dialog of the Server Configuration manager appears.  
352  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10 Firmware update  
This chapter provides you with information about the following topics:  
iRMC S2/S3 firmware (overview)  
Creating a memory stick for updating the firmware  
Updating firmware images  
Emergency flash  
flash tools  
I
The current firmware versions are present on the ServerView Suite DVD 1  
or can be downloaded manually from the Download section of the Fujitsu  
Technology Solutions web server.  
You can obtain the up-to-date version of the ServerView Suite DVD 1 at  
I two-monthly intervals.  
Besides the possibility of performing a firmware update, you can also  
I downgrade the firmware to the previous version.  
Before updating or downgrading the firmware, read the supplementary  
documentation supplied with the new firmware carefully (in particular the  
I Readme files).  
Servers with iRMC S2 must be rebooted to activate the updated /  
downgraded firmware. For servers with iRMC S3, no reboot is required  
to activate the updated / downgraded firmware.  
V
CAUTION!  
When updating / downgrading the firmware, note that the problem-free  
operation of the firmware can only be guaranteed if the runtime firmware  
and the SDR (Sensor Data Record, see page 355) both belong to the  
same firmware release.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
353  
 
iRMC S2/S3 firmware (overview)  
10.1 iRMC S2/S3 firmware (overview)  
The iRMC S2/S3 uses two different firmware images. The two firmware images  
are stored on a 16-MB EEPROM (Electrically Erasable Programmable Read-  
Only Memory):  
Firmware image 1 (low FW image)  
Firmware image 2 (high FW image)  
The firmware of the iRMC S2/S3 is not executed in the EEPROM, but is instead  
loaded into SRAM memory on startup and executed there. This means that it is  
possible to update both active and inactive firmware images online, i.e. with the  
server operating system (Windows or Linux) running.  
I
If an error occurs while loading the firmware from one of the images, the  
I firmware is automatically loaded from the other image.  
Information on the iRMC S2/S3 firmware and EEPROM can be found  
in the iRMC S2/S3 web interface, page iRMC S2/S3 Information (see  
page 164) or  
using the flash tool (see page 368).  
Active and passive firmware image  
One of the two firmware images is active (running) at any given time, while the  
other is inactive. The firmware image that is active depends on the so-called  
firmware selector (see page 356).  
354  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iRMC S2/S3 firmware (overview)  
Structure of the iRMC S2/S3 EEPROM  
The EEPROM of the iRMC S2/S3 contains one area for firmware image 1 and  
one area for firmware image 2:  
8 MB for  
firmware image 2  
Runtime firmware  
SDRR (and configuration table)  
not used  
8 MB for  
Runtime firmware  
firmware image 1  
SDRR (and configuration table)  
Bootloader  
Figure 217: Structure of the iRMC S2/S3 EEPROM  
Bootloader  
The bootloader checks the firmware image that is currently active. If a  
firmware error is detected, the bootloader sets the firmware selector to the  
other firmware image.  
SDRR (Sensor Data Record Repository)  
The SDRR contains the Sensor Data Records (SDR) in which sensor  
information for the managed server is stored. The SDRR also acts as an  
interface via which you can access the SDRs.  
Runtime firmware  
The runtime firmware is the executable part of the iRMC S2/S3's firmware.  
You can perform a firmware update for each of these areas.  
iRMC S2/S3  
355  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iRMC S2/S3 firmware (overview)  
Firmware selector  
The firmware selector specifies the iRMC S2/S3 firmware to be executed. Every  
time the iRMC S2/S3 is reset and restarted, the firmware selector is evaluated  
and processing branches to the corresponding firmware.  
The firmware selector can have the following values:  
0
1
2
3
4
5
Firmware image containing the most recent firmware version  
firmware image 1  
firmware image 2  
Firmware image containing the oldest firmware version  
Firmware image most recently updated  
Firmware image that has been updated least recently  
I
Depending on the update variant used, the firmware selector is set  
differently after the update.  
You can query and explicitly set the firmware selector  
on the iRMC S2/S3 Information page of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
or  
using the flash tool (see page 368).  
356  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting up the USB memory stick  
10.2 Setting up the USB memory stick  
I
You do not need the USB memory stick if you update the firmware of the  
iRMC S2/S3 in one of the following ways:  
using the ServerView Update Manager  
using ServerView Update Manager Express or ASP  
using the iRMC S2/S3 web interface and TFTP server  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Download the firmware iRMC Firmware Update for USB Stick from the  
Download section of the Fujitsu Technology Solutions web server to a  
directory on your computer.  
The ZIP archive FTS_<spec>.zip can be found in your download directory.  
(The <spec> part of the name provides information on the system type,  
system board, firmware/SDRR version etc.)  
The ZIP archive includes the following files:  
USBImage.exe  
iRMC_<Firmware-Version>.exe  
iRMC_<Firmware-Version>.IMA  
Ê
Ê
Connect the USB memory stick to your computer.  
Start the file iRMC_<Firmware-Version>.exe or the file USBImag.exe.  
One of the following windows is opened depending on the file you call (see  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
357  
 
Setting up the USB memory stick  
Figure 218: Copying the image file to the USB memory stick  
(with iRMC_<Firmware version.exe))  
Figure 219: Copying the image file to the USB memory stick (with USBImage.exe)  
I
If you have called USBImag.exe, then under Image File:, you must  
explicitly specify the file iRMC_<Firmware-Version>.IMA.  
Ê
Click Clear USB Device to delete the data from the USB memory stick.  
358  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting up the USB memory stick  
Ê
Click Copy Image File to USB Device to copy the file  
BMC_<Firmware-Version>.IMA to the USB memory stick and extract it.  
V
CAUTION!  
This action overwrites the content of the USB memory stick.  
When the copy operation is complete, the flash tools and image files are present  
on the USB memory stick.  
Figure 220: Image files and flash tool on the USB memory stick.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
359  
Updating firmware images  
10.3 Updating firmware images  
Since the iRMC S2/S3 firmware executes in the SRAM memory of the  
iRMC S2/S3, it is possible to update both active and inactive firmware images  
online, i.e. with the server operating system running.  
The following methods are available for updating the firmware images:  
over the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
using the ServerView Update Manager  
using ServerView Update Manager Express or ASP  
Update using the operating system flash tools.  
Downgrading the firmware to the previous version  
Besides the possibility of performing a firmware update, you can also  
downgrade the firmware to the previous version.  
The simplest way to downgrade the firmware is to store the previous-version  
firmware image as the inactive firmware image in the EEPROM of the  
iRMC S2/S3. In this case, you only have to set the firmware selector to this  
previous-version image (see page 182) and subsequently restart the  
iRMC S2/S3 to activate the firmware.  
I
You can also downgrade the firmware by applying the methods described  
in the following sections. In these cases, you perform a firmware update  
based on the firmware of the previous version. Special requirements to  
perform the downgrade are pointed out separately in the following  
sections.  
10.3.1 Update via the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
The iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update page allows you to update the firmware of the  
iRMC S2/S3 by providing the firmware image either locally on the remote  
workstation or on a TFTP server (see section "iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Update"  
360  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Updating firmware images  
10.3.2 Update using the ServerView Update Manager  
Using the ServerView Update Manager, you can start the update of the  
iRMC S2/S3 firmware via a graphical user interface or via a command line  
interface (Windows and Linux). The ServerView Update Manager accesses the  
update data via its Update Repository on the ServerView Suite DVD 1 or on the  
management server. You update the update repository on the management  
server by means of the Download Manager or by performing a manual  
download from the Download section of the Fujitsu Technology Solutions web  
server.  
For more detailed information on firmware updates with the ServerView Update  
Manager, see the “ServerView Update Manager” manual.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
361  
 
Updating firmware images  
10.3.3 Online update using ServerView Update Manager  
Express or ASP  
Under Windows and Linux operating systems, you can update the iRMC S2/S3  
firmware either using the graphical user interface of ServerView Update  
Manager Express or by using the ASP (Autonomous Support Package)  
command interface.  
Under Windows, you can also start an ASP in the Windows Explorer by double-  
clicking the corresponding ASP-*.exe file.  
I
When downgrading the firmware, please note:  
Downgrade via Update Manager Express:  
The firmware downgrade is only feasible in the Expert mode. In  
addition, the Downgrade option must be activated.  
Downgrade via ASP:  
Under Windows:  
You can perform the downgrade if you start the ASP by double-  
clicking the corresponding *.exe file. When starting the ASP via the  
CLI, you must explicitly specify the Force=yes option.  
Under Linux:  
You must explicitly specify option -f or option --force.  
For more detailed information on firmware updates with Update Manager  
Express and ASP, see the “Local System Update for PRIMERGY Servers”  
manual.  
362  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Updating firmware images  
10.3.4 Update using the operating system flash tools.  
I
An online update using the operating system flash tools is only  
I performed as a recovery flash, i.e. no version check is performed.  
Prerequisite:  
The flash tools and the files for the firmware update must be present in  
the file system of the managed server.  
You use one of the following flash tools, depending on the operating system you  
are running:  
DOS:  
flirmcs2  
Windows:  
winflirmcs2  
Prerequisite:  
The ServerView agents for the used Windows operation  
system (32/64 bit) must be running on the managed server.  
Windows (32 bit): win32flirmcs2 (No agents required.)  
Windows (64 bit): win64flirmcs2 (No agents required.)  
Linux:  
linflirmcs2  
You call the flash tools in the Windows command line (flirmcs2, win32flirmcs2,  
win64flirmcs2, winflirmcs2) or at the Linux CLI (linflirmcs2).  
The syntax and operands for the flash tools are described in section "Flash  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
363  
 
Updating firmware images  
Proceed as follows:  
An online update using a USB memory stick is described below (see  
Ê
Connect the USB memory stick to the managed server.  
Ê
In the Windows command line or the Linux Command Line Interface (CLI)  
switch to the drive corresponding to the USB memory stick.  
Ê
Ê
Set the firmware selector to the value 4 by calling the flash tool with the  
parameter /s 4.  
E.g., in the Windows command line you enter:  
WinFLIRMCS2 /s 4  
Start the update of the firmware and the SDR data by calling the flash tool  
with the corresponding update files.  
E.g., in the Windows command line you enter:  
WinFLIRMCS2 dcod<firmware-version>.bin <nnnnnnn>.sdr /i  
During the firmware update, the console informs you about the progress of  
the update operation. If an error occurs, the update operation is aborted and  
a corresponding return code is reported (see page 370).  
Ê
Restart the managed server. This automatically activates the firmware  
image with the updated firmware.  
364  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Updating firmware images  
10.3.5 Update via the lashDisk menu  
I
For an update via the FlashDisk menu, you require a bootable USB  
Proceed as follows:  
Ê
Connect the USB memory stick to the managed server (directly or via  
remote storage).  
Ê
Boot from the USB memory stick.  
After completion of the boot operation, the data in the USB memory stick is  
automatically copied to a RAM disk. The autoexec.bat file is then started  
automatically.  
The FlashDisk menu opens:  
Figure 221: FlashDisk menu  
I
A firmware downgrade is only possible via recovery flash.  
Normal  
A normal flash is performed.  
During a normal flash operation, those areas of the EEPROM that  
contain the active firmware are checked to see whether they are up to  
date. If one of these areas is not up to date then the corresponding area  
for the inactive firmware is updated if it is not already up to date.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
365  
 
Updating firmware images  
Recovery _L  
A recovery flash for firmware image 1 (low firmware image) is carried out.  
In the case of a recovery flash, the flash is performed for all three areas  
of firmware image 1 without any version check.  
Recovery _U  
A recovery flash for firmware image 2 (high firmware image) is carried out.  
In the case of a recovery flash, the flash is performed for all three areas  
of firmware image 2 without any version check.  
Readme  
The Readme file is opened.  
Reboot  
An iRMC S2/S3 warm start is performed.  
English / German  
Specify keyboard layout. German is set by default.  
Ê
Start the required update variant by clicking on the corresponding button.  
During the firmware update, the console informs you about the progress of  
the update operation. If an error occurs, the update operation is aborted. A  
corresponding return code is reported (see page 370).  
Ê
Once the update operation has been completed, click on Exit, to close the  
FlashDisk menu.  
Ê
Ê
Remove the USB memory stick from the managed server.  
Restart the managed server (e.g. with [Ctrl]+[Alt]+[Del]).  
366  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Emergency flash  
10.4 Emergency flash  
If the iRMC S2/S3 firmware can no longer be executed, e.g. because the SDRs  
are not compatible with the system, then you can use the emergency mode to  
start the firmware running again. In emergency mode, the system automatically  
branches to the bootloader and is the ready for the firmware update.  
I
Emergency mode is indicated by the error LED (global error LED) (rot)  
and the identification LED (blue) flashing alternately.  
To switch the managed server to emergency mode and then update the  
iRMC S2/S3's firmware, proceed as follows:  
Ê
Ê
Disconnect the power supply connector.  
Insert the connector in the socket again with the Identify key held down.  
The managed server is now in emergency mode.  
Ê
Boot the server to DOS and use the recovery flash procedure to update the  
iRMC S2/S3’s firmware.  
I
If the firmware is not active then the boot operation may take up to 2  
minutes to start. You can ignore the error message “iRMC S2/S3  
Controller Error” which the BIOS outputs during this period.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
367  
 
Flash tools  
10.5 Flash tools  
I
The tools WinFLIRMCS2, rFLIRMCS2 and sFLIRMCS2 differ from  
flirmcs2 only in respect of the name and the environment in which they  
are called. This means that the description below also applies to  
WinFLIRMCS2, rFLIRMCS2 and sFLIRMCS2. Instead of “flirmcs2”, you  
simply enter “WinFLRMCS2”, “rFLIRMCS2” or “sFLIRMCS2” as  
appropriate.  
Syntax  
flirmcs2 {/v|/o [/4]|/s[<value>]}  
flirmcs2 {<file1> [<file2>] [<file3>]  
[/n /l[<logfile>] /d /e /4 /i]}  
flirmcs2 {/h|/?}  
Options  
/v  
/o  
/s  
Displays the current version of the command.  
Displays the current versions of both firmware images.  
Displays the value of the firmware selector.  
/s <value>  
Sets the value of the firmware selector. You use this option to define the  
firmware image from which the firmware is started after a firmware reset.  
0
Sets the selector to the firmware image with the most recent  
firmware.  
1
2
3
4
Sets the selector to firmware image 1.  
Sets the selector to firmware image 2.  
Sets the selector to the firmware image with the oldest firmware.  
Sets the selector to the firmware image with the most recently  
updated firmware.  
5
Sets the selector to the firmware image with the firmware which  
has not been updated for longest.  
368  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Flash tools  
<file1> through <file3>  
Specify one or more files to determine which updates are to be made:  
The following files are to be selected:  
boot<FW-Version>.bin  
Updates the bootloader firmware.  
dcod<FW-Version>.bin  
Updates the runtime firmware.  
<SDR-Version>.SDR  
I Updates the SDR.  
To update firmware image 2, you must also specify option /4 (see  
below).  
/4  
Updating firmware image 2.  
/l [<logfile>]  
Outputs error messages to the specified log file. If no logfile is specified,  
the output is directed to the flbmc.log file.  
/n  
No output on the console.  
This option has priority over the /p and /d options.  
/np  
A rotating bar is shown in place of the percentage completion during the  
flashing operation.  
/d  
/e  
/i  
Outputs additional debug information.  
Emulation mode (for debugging purposes only).  
Update the inactive firmware.  
/h and /?  
Outputs help information.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
369  
Flash tools  
Return values  
0
1
3
4
5
8
9
Firmware update was executed successfully.  
Illegal or missing arguments.  
PROM type not available  
Communication with iRMC S2/S3 not possible.  
Incorrect binary file.  
Error accessing Keyboard Control Style interface (KCS).  
Timeout during communication with the target EEPROM.  
10 No buffer allocated.  
12 Network node busy.  
13 Timeout erasing EEPROM.  
14 Timeout flashing EEPROM.  
15 Error erasing EEPROM.  
16 Error flashing EEPROM.  
370  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11 Remote installation of the  
operating system via iRMC S2/S3  
This chapter describes how you use the ServerView Installation Manager  
(abbreviated to Installation Manager below) and the iRMC S2/S3 features  
"Advanced Video Redirection (AVR)" and "Remote Storage" to install the  
operating system on the administered server from the remote workstation.  
The chapter discusses the following specific topics:  
General procedure for the remote installation of an operating system using  
remote storage media.  
Booting the administered server from the remote workstation using  
ServerView DVD 1 (Windows and Linux).  
Installing Windows from the remote workstation after configuration on the  
administered server.  
Installing Linux from the remote workstation after configuration on the  
managed server.  
The description focuses primarily on the handling of the remote storage media.  
It is assumed that readers are familiar with the Installation Manager functionality  
(see the manual "ServerView Installation Manager").  
I
Prerequisites for the remote installation of the operating system via  
iRMC S2/S3:  
The iRMC S2/S3’s LAN interface must be configured  
(see page 41).  
The license key for the use of the iRMC S2/S3 functions “Advanced  
Video Redirection (AVR)” and “Remote Storage” must be installed  
(see page 167).  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
371  
   
General procedure  
11.1 Installing the operating system via  
iRMC S2/S3 - general procedure  
For the Installation Manager, the remote installation of the operating system via  
iRMC S2/S3 represents a local configuration and installation of the operating  
system on the administered server which you perform from the remote  
workstation via the AVR window using remote storage media.  
The following steps are required in order to perform an installation via the  
Installation Manager:  
1. Connect the storage medium (DVD 1 or Installation Manager boot image)  
from which you want to boot as remote storage.  
2. Boot and configure the managed server via DVD 1 or the Installation  
Manager boot image.  
3. Use the Installation Manager at the remote workstation to install the  
operating system on the administered server.  
4. Optimize mouse pointer synchronization in the AVR window (only necessary  
under Linux).  
Installing Windows without the Installation Manager using the Windows  
installation CD/DVDs  
You can perform a remote installation of Windows via Remote Storage either  
using the Installation Manager or exclusively using the Windows installation  
CD/DVDs. The two procedures correspond in terms of the handling of the  
remote storage media.  
However, you are advised to install Windows via the Installation Manager for the  
following reasons:  
The Installation Manager itself identifies the required drivers and copies  
these to the system.  
All the Installation Manager functions are available to you during installation.  
This means that you can, for example, configure the entire system including  
the server management settings.  
Installations without the Installation Manager have to be controlled via the  
keyboard since the mouse cursor cannot be synchronized during the  
installation process. In contrast, if you install using the Installation Manager  
then all configuration and installation steps can be performed using the  
mouse.  
372  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
General procedure  
If you install without the Installation Manager then all the settings required  
for mouse cursor synchronization must subsequently be performed  
manually.  
Installation using the Installation Manager does not take significantly longer  
than installation using the operating system CD/DVDs.  
Installing Linux without the Installation Manager using the Linux  
installation CD/DVD  
If you know which drivers are required by the system then you can start the  
Linux installation by booting from the Linux installation CD/DVD.  
If the installation requires you to integrate drivers from the floppy disk then,  
before starting the installation, you must set up a remote storage connection  
to the storage medium (CD-ROM/DVD-ROM or ISO image) from which you  
want to boot and  
if necessary to storage medium for driver installation.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
373  
Remote Storage connections  
11.2 Connecting a storage medium as remote  
storage  
Remote Storage makes a “virtual” drive available which is located elsewhere in  
the network.  
The source for the virtual drive can be:  
Physical drive or image file at the remote workstation. The image file may  
also be on a network drive (with drive letter, e.g. “D:” for drive D).  
Image file provided centrally in the network by means of a remote storage  
server.  
I
Parallel remote storage connections:  
The following are possible concurrently:  
either up to two Remote Storage connections to virtual drives at the  
remote workstation (if the connection is established over the AVR  
Java applet)  
or  
one Remote Storage connection to a Remote Storage server.  
It is not possible to establish concurrent Remote Storage connections via  
I an applet and via the Remote Storage server.  
The Remote Storage page of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface allows you to  
obtain information on the status of the current remote storage  
connections (see page 312).  
For detailed information on remote storage, see chapter "Remote Storage" on  
374  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Remote Storage connections  
Connecting a storage medium as remote storage at the remote storage  
workstation  
Proceed as follows at the remote workstation to establish the remote storage  
connection:  
Ê
Log into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface with Remote Storage Enabled  
permission (see page 136).  
Ê
Open the Advanced Video Redirection (AVR) page and start the AVR (see  
Ê
Ê
Start “Remote Storage” in the AVR window (see page 114).  
Prepare the storage media for remote storage (see page 117):  
If installation is performed via the Installation Manager:  
ServerView Suite DVD 1 or an Installation Manager boot image and  
optionally a formatted USB memory stick as a status backup medium.  
If installation is performed from the vendor’s installation CD/DVD:  
Windows or Linux installation CD/DVD and optional drivers.  
I
It is recommended that the ServerView Suite DVD 1 and the  
operating system installation CD/DVD are stored in a folder as an  
image file (ISO image) and that they are connected from there as  
Remote Storage or provided via a Remote Storage server.  
The prepared storage media are displayed in the Storage Devices dialog box.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
375  
Remote Storage connections  
Figure 222: Storage Devices dialog box: ServerView Suite DVD 1  
Ê
Click Connect to connect the DVD ROM drive (DVD 1) or the Installation  
Manager boot image as remote storage.  
Connect the ISO image (image file) provided by the remote storage server  
as remote storage  
You can use an image file provided via the remote storage server for booting  
from an Installation Manager boot image.  
I
Before it is possible to use a virtual drive provided via a remote storage  
server, the remote storage server must be installed and started (see  
To establish the connection to the remote storage server, proceed as follows at  
the remote workstation:  
Ê
Log into the iRMC S2/S3 web interface with Remote Storage Enabled  
permission (see page 136).  
Ê
Ê
Select the Remote Storage page.  
Establish the connection to the remote storage server (see page 314).  
376  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Booting from DVD 1  
11.3 Booting the managed server from  
ServerView Suite DVD 1 and configuring it  
with the Installation Manager  
Proceed as follows at the remote workstation:  
Ê
Use the iRMC S2/S3 web interface to start up the managed server or reboot  
the server (see page 189). You can follow the progress of the boot process  
in the AVR window.  
During the managed server’s BIOS/TrustedCore/UEFI POST phase, remote  
storage media are displayed as USB 2.0 devices. Remote Storage storage  
media are represented by the following entries in the BIOS boot sequence:  
A (physical) floppy disk is represented by a separate entry  
“FTS RemoteStorage FD-(USB 2.0)”.  
All other remote storage device types are represented by the shared  
entry “CD-ROM DRIVE”.  
I
If a local CD-ROM/DVD-ROM drive and a CD-ROM/DVD-ROM  
drive connected as remote storage are both present at the  
managed server then the managed server boots from the Remote  
Storage CD-ROM/DVD-ROM drive.  
Ê
Ê
Press [F2] while the server is booting.  
In the BIOS/TrustedCore/UEFI set-up, open the menu Boot in which you can  
define the boot sequence.  
Ê
Ê
Specify Boot Priority=1 (highest priority) for the ServerView Suite DVD 1  
which is connected as remote storage.  
Save your settings and exit the BIOS/TrustedCore/UEFI setup.  
The managed server then boots from ServerView Suite DVD 1 which is  
connected as remote storage.  
I
If the system does not boot from the remote storage medium  
(ServerView Suite DVD 1 or Installation Manager boot image):  
Ê
Check whether the storage medium is displayed during the BIOS  
POST phase and connect the storage medium as remote storage if  
necessary.  
Ê
Make sure that the correct boot sequence is specified.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
377  
 
Booting from DVD 1  
It takes about 5 minutes to boot from ServerView Suite DVD 1 via a remote  
storage medium. The boot progress is indicated during the boot process. Once  
the boot process has completed, the Installation Manager startup displays a  
dialog box in which you are asked to select a medium for the status backup area  
(status backup medium).  
I
Before you start to install the operating system, you should synchronize  
the local mouse cursor and the cursor of the managed server in the AVR  
window at the remote workstation. For more detailed information on  
synchronizing the mouse cursor in the AVR window, see section  
Ê
Ê
Choose Standard mode as the Installation Manager mode.  
Specify whether the configuration data is to be stored on a local replaceable  
data medium or on a network medium:  
I
Please note that if you do not select any status backup option all the  
configuration data is lost when you reboot.  
Status backup medium  
The backup medium must not be write-protected.  
I
A USB stick must already be connected to the USB port when  
the system is booted. If you fail to do this and wish to save the  
configuration file: Connect the USB stick now and reboot from  
ServerView Suite DVD 1.  
Ê
Ê
Choose the option on local drive (floppy / USB stick).  
Select the corresponding drive in the box to the right of this option.  
For more detailed information on creating Installation Manager  
status disks, see the manual “ServerView Installation Manager”.  
Connecting the status medium and/or the installation media via the network  
Set up the required shares for this purpose.  
Ê
I
If you are making a medium with a prepared configuration  
file and/or an installation medium available via the network,  
you have to choose this option. Depending on your  
infrastructure, you can either obtain a temporary IP  
address via DHCP or manually configure an IPv4 or IPv6  
address for the current Installation Manager session.  
Ê
Start the Installation Manager by clicking Continue.  
378  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Booting from DVD 1  
Starting local deployment  
The Welcome screen appears when you start the Installation Manager:  
Figure 223: Installation Manager - Welcome screen  
Ê
Click Deployment to start preparation of the local installation (deployment).  
To prepare the installation, the Installation Manager wizards take you  
through a sequence of configuration steps that gather specifications for  
configuring the system and for subsequent unattended installation of the  
operating system.  
I
Configure the local CD ROM/DVD ROM drive of the managed server  
as the installation source. You can then also make the Windows  
installation CD/DVD available from the CD ROM/DVD ROM drive of  
the remote workstation if you connect it to the managed server as  
Once you have completed configuration with the Installation Manager, the  
Installation Info dialog page for the Windows installation (see page 380) or for  
the Linux installation (see page 383) is displayed. This allows you to start the  
installation process.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
379  
Installing the operating system  
11.4 Installing the operating system on the  
managed server after configuration  
Once you have completed configuration, you should install the operating system  
on the managed server.  
11.4.1 Installing Windows on the managed server after  
configuration  
After configuration has been completed, the Installation Manager displays the  
following dialog page:  
Figure 224: Installation Manager - Installation Info page  
380  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Installing the operating system  
If you have configured the local CD ROM/DVD ROM drive of the managed  
server as the installation source, proceed as follows at the remote workstation:  
Ê
Ê
Ê
Clear your currently active remote storage connections. For more detailed  
information on clearing remote storage connections, see page 125.  
Remove ServerView Suite DVD 1 from the DVD ROM drive at the remote  
workstation.  
Insert the Windows installation CD/DVD in this DVD ROM drive.  
I
Close the application if autostart is active.  
Ê
Ê
Connect the CD ROM/DVD ROM drive containing the Windows installation  
CD/DVD as remote storage (see page 121).  
In the Installation Info page of the Installation Manager, click Start installation.  
All the installation files are copied to the managed server.  
The Installation Manager opens a confirmation dialog page when the copy  
operation is complete and prompts you to remove all the storage media from  
the removable media drives before the managed server is rebooted.  
I
Before rebooting the system, you must in particular shut down all  
current remote storage connections.  
Ê
To shut down all current remote storage connections, proceed as follows:  
Ê
Start “Remote Storage” (see page 114).  
The Storage Devices dialog box is displayed with the currently connected  
storage devices and a “Safe Remove” indication.  
Ê
Ê
“Safely remove” the storage device, i.e. ensure that no more  
applications/programs are accessing the storage media.  
Click on Disconnect... to remove all the remote storage connections.  
Ê
On the confirmation dialog page, click Ok to reboot the managed server.  
Once the managed server has rebooted, you can monitor the entire installation  
by means of the AVR.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
381  
Installing the operating system  
I
For a Windows installation from the Windows installation CD/DVD:  
To ensure perfect mouse cursor synchronization, you must adapt the  
following settings at the managed server once the operating system has  
been installed:  
Speed of the mouse pointer  
Hardware acceleration  
For information on how to do this, see section "Managed Windows  
If Windows is installed using the Installation Manager, problem-free  
synchronization of the mouse pointers is automatically ensured.  
382  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the operating system  
11.4.2 Installing Linux on the managed server after  
configuration  
I
I
The mouse can be used but not synchronized during Linux installation.  
Whenever you change a remote storage medium, you must remove the  
remote storage connection for the currently connected medium and then  
connect the new medium as remote storage.  
After configuration has been completed, the Installation Manager displays the  
following dialog page:  
Figure 225: Installation Manager - Installation Info  
If you have configured the local CD ROM/DVD ROM drive of the managed  
server as the installation source, proceed as follows at the remote workstation:  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
383  
 
Installing the operating system  
Ê
Ê
Ê
Clear your currently active remote storage connections. For more detailed  
information on clearing remote storage connections, see page 125.  
Remove ServerView Suite DVD 1 from the  
DVD ROM drive at the remote workstation.  
Insert the Linux installation CD/DVD in this DVD ROM drive.  
I
Close the application if autostart is active.  
Ê
Ê
Connect the CD ROM/DVD ROM drive containing the Linux installation  
CD/DVD as remote storage (see page 121).  
In the Installation Info page of the Installation Manager, click Start installation.  
All the installation files are copied to the managed server. The Installation  
Manager opens a confirmation dialog page when the copy operation is  
complete and prompts you to remove all the storage media from the  
removable media drives before the managed server is rebooted.  
I
Before rebooting the system, you must in particular shut down all  
current remote storage connections.  
Ê
Before rebooting the system, shut down the current remote storage  
connections.  
To do this, proceed as follows:  
Ê
Start “Remote Storage” (see page 114).  
The Storage Devices dialog box is displayed with the currently connected  
storage devices and a “Safe Remove” indication.  
Ê
Ê
Click on Disconnect... to remove all the remote storage connections.  
“Safely remove” the storage device, i.e. ensure that no more  
applications/programs are accessing the storage media.  
Ê
On the confirmation dialog page, click Ok to reboot the managed server.  
Once the managed server has rebooted, you can monitor the entire installation  
by means of the AVR.  
I
To ensure perfect mouse cursor synchronization, you must adapt the  
required settings at the managed server once the operating system has  
been installed. For information on how to do this, see section "Managed  
384  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12 Appendix  
The appendix provides you with information about the following topics:  
12.1 IPMI OEM Commands supported by the  
iRMC S2/S3  
This section describes a selection of OEM-specific IPMI commands supported  
by the iRMC S2/S3.  
12.1.1 Overview  
The following OEM-specific IPMI commands are supported by the iRMC S2/S3:  
SCCI-compliant Power On/Off commands  
(SCCI: ServerView Common Command Interface)  
0115 Get Power On Source  
0116 Get Power Off Source  
011C Set Power Off Inhibit  
011D Get Power Off Inhibit  
0120 Set Next Power On Time  
SCCI-compliant communication commands  
0205 System OS Shutdown Request  
0206 System OS Shutdown Request and Reset  
0208 Agent Connect Status  
0209 Shutdown Request Canceled  
SCCI-compliant signaling commands  
1002 Write to System Display  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
385  
     
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
Firmware-specific commands  
2004 Set Firmware Selector  
2005 Get Firmware Selector  
C019 Get Remote Storage Connection  
C01A Set Video Display on/off  
BIOS-specific command  
F109 Get BIOS POST State  
F115 Get CPU Info  
iRMC S2/S3-specific commands  
F510 Get System Status  
F512 Get EEPROM Version Info  
F542 Get HDD lightpath status (Component Status Signal Read)  
F543 Get SEL entry long text  
F545 Get SEL entry text  
F5B0 Set Identify LED  
F5B1 Get Identify LED  
F5B3 Get Error LED  
F5DF Set Nonvolatile Cfg Memory to Default Values  
F5E0 Set Configuration Space to Default Values  
F5F8 Delete User ID  
386  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
12.1.2 Description of the IPMI OEM commands  
The following sections describe the individual OEM-specific IPMI commands.  
12.1.2.1 Description format  
The OEM-specific IPMI commands contained in this chapter are described in  
the format used by the IPMI standard for describing IPMI commands.  
The IPMI standard describes the IPMI commands using command tables which  
list the input and output parameters for each command.  
You can find information on the IPMI standards on the Internet under:  
http://developer.intel.com/design/servers/ipmi/index.htm  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
387  
   
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
12.1.2.2 SCCI-compliant Power On/Off commands  
01 15 - Get Power On Source  
This command returns the reason for the most recent Power On. The possible  
reasons are listed below.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
01  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
15  
BC  
01  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
3
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
01  
Data Length  
4
Power on Source: Cause of last power on  
Power on  
Source  
Description  
0x00  
0x01  
0x02  
0x03  
0x04  
0x05  
0x08  
0x09  
Software or command  
Power switch (on the front panel or keyboard)  
Automatic restart after power failure  
Clock or timer (hardware RTC or software timer)  
Automatic restart after fan failure shutdown  
Automatic restart after critical temperature shutdown  
Reboot after watchdog timeout  
Remote on (modem RI line, SCSI termination power, LAN, chip card  
reader...)  
0x0C  
0x15  
0x16  
0x1A  
0x1D  
0x1E  
Reboot after a CPU error  
Reboot by hardware reset  
Reboot after warm start  
Powered on by a PCI Bus Power Management Event  
Powered on by remote control via remote manager  
Reboot/reset by remote control via remote manager  
388  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
01 16 - Get Power Off Source  
This command returns the reason for the most recent Power Off. The possible  
reasons are listed below.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
01  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
16  
BC  
01  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
3
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
01  
Data Length  
4
Power off Source: Cause of last power off  
Power off  
Source  
Description  
0x00  
0x01  
0x02  
0x03  
0x04  
0x05  
0x08  
0x0C  
0x1D  
Software (SWOFF, power off by command)  
Power switch (on the front panel or keyboard)  
AC power fail  
Clock or timer (hardware RTC or software timer)  
Fan failure  
Critical temperature  
Final power-off after repeated watchdog timeouts  
Final power-off after repeated CPU errors  
Powered off by remote control via remote manager  
iRMC S2/S3  
389  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
01 1C - Set Power Off Inhibit  
This command sets the Power Off Inhibit flag, which temporarily suppresses any  
unfounded attempt to power down the server.  
If the Power Off Inhibit flag is set, the firmware saves the cause of any attempt to  
perform a “Power Off”, “Power Cycle” or restart of the server, but does not  
perform the action. The cause of the most recent attempt to perform a “Power  
Off”, “Power Cycle” or restart of the server is always saved at any given time.  
The stored action is only performed when the Power Off Inhibit flag is reset.  
The Power Off Inhibit flag is automatically reset after a power failure or when the  
reset button is pressed.  
The effect of the Power Off Inhibit flag is the same as that of the Dump flag used  
when creating a main memory dump. In this case, the initiator must set the flag  
before making the dump and reset it when the dump is complete.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
01  
NetFn|LUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
1C  
00  
Command Specifier  
Object ID  
5
6:7  
8
00 00 Value ID  
01  
Data Length  
9
Power Off Inhibit Flag: 0 no Inhibit, 1 Inhibit  
Response Data  
-
BC  
-
01  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
390  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
01 1D - Get Power Off Inhibit  
This command gets the value of the Power Off Inhibit flag.  
For further details on the Power Off Inhibit flag, see the description of  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
01  
NetFn|LUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
1D  
BC  
01  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
01 Response Data Length  
6
Power Off Inhibit Flag: 0 no Inhibit, 1 Inhibit  
iRMC S2/S3  
391  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
01 20 - Set Next Power On Time  
This command switches on a system at the given time independent of the stored  
On/Off times in the Configuration Space.  
I
The command takes effect only once.  
You cancel a “Power On” time previously set with a 01 20 command by  
specifying the “Power On” time “0” in a subsequent 01 20 command.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
01  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
20  
00  
Command Specifier  
Object ID  
5
6:7  
8
00 00 Value ID  
04 Data Length  
9:12  
-
Time (LSB first) (see below)  
Response Data  
BC  
-
01  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
Time (LSB first)  
Time (UNIX-specific format) when the system switches on again. Time is  
NOT stored in non-volatile memory. Resolution is 1 minute. After the  
system has switched on, Time is set to 0 internally.  
If Time == 0, the system is not switched on.  
392  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
12.1.2.3 SCCI-compliant communication commands  
I
Die SCCI-compliant communication commands require that the Agent  
Service is running under the OS. To execute the commands, the  
iRMC S2/S3 communicates with Agent which finally performs the action.  
02 05 - System OS Shutdown Request  
This command initiates shutdown of the server’s operating system.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
02  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
05  
BC  
02  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
02 06 - System OS Shutdown Request and Reset  
This command initiates the shutdown of the server’s operating system and  
subsequently restarts the system.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
02  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
06  
BC  
02  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
iRMC S2/S3  
393  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
02 08 - Agent Connect Status  
This command checks whether the agent is active.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
02  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
08  
BC  
02  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
01  
Data Length  
6
Connect Status:  
00 = Connection lost, agent not connected.  
01 = Connection re-established, agent connected.  
02 09 Shutdown Request Cancelled  
This command cancels a shutdown request that has been issued.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
02  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Communication  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
09  
BC  
02  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
394  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
12.1.2.4 SCCI-compliant signaling command  
10 02 - Write to System Display  
This command is used to write characters to the LocalView display (if  
connected).  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
10  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Fan Test  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
02 Command Specifier  
5
Object Index: : Line on Display to write on.  
Value ID (not used)  
6:7  
8
Length Number of characters to write, incremented by  
one. (The string need not be null-terminated; characters  
exceeding the length of a display line are truncated.)  
9
Attribute:  
0 = Write String left aligned.  
1 = Write String centered.  
10:10+n Characters to write to the display; string need not be null-  
terminated.  
Response Data  
-
-
BC  
10  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
iRMC S2/S3  
395  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
12.1.2.5 Firmware-specific commands  
20 04 - Set Firmware Selector  
This command configures the firmware image of the iRMC S2/S3 which is to be  
active after a firmware reset.  
Request Data  
-
-
20  
04  
NetFnlLUN: Firmware  
CMD : Command Group Firmware  
1
Selector:  
0 = Auto (Select firmware image with highest firmware  
version.)  
1 = low firmware image  
2 = high firmware image  
3 = Auto oldest version (Select firmware image with oldest  
firmware version.)  
4 = MRP (Select most recently programmed firmware.)  
5 = LRP (Select least recently programmed firmware.)  
Response Data  
-
-
24  
04  
1
Completion Code  
396  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
20 05 - Get Firmware Selector  
This command returns the current firmware selector setting.  
Request Data  
-
-
20  
05  
24  
05  
NetFnlLUN: Firmware  
CMD : Command Group Firmware  
Response Data  
-
-
1
2
Completion Code  
Next Boot Selector:  
0 = Auto (Select EEPROM with highest firmware version.)  
1 = low EEPROM  
2 = high EEPROM  
3 = Auto oldest version (Select EEPROM oldest firmware  
version.)  
4 = MRP (Select most recently programmed firmware.)  
5 = LRP (Select least recently programmed firmware.)  
3
Running Selector; tells which firmware is currently running:  
1 = low EEPROM  
2 = high EEPROM  
iRMC S2/S3  
397  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
C0 19 - Get Remote Storage Connection or Status  
Depending on the parameters passed, this command returns information on  
whether any Remote Storage connections are available,  
the status and type of any Remote Storage connection(s).  
If Request Data 1 is set to “1”, the command returns information as to whether  
storage media are connected as Remote Storage.  
Request Data  
-
-
C0  
19  
01  
00  
00  
C4  
19  
NetFnlLUN: OEM  
CMD : Command Group Firmware  
1
2
3
-
Response Data  
-
1
2
3
Completion Code  
01  
00: No  
01: Yes, connected  
4
5
00  
00  
398  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
If Request Data 1 is set to “2”, the command returns information on the status and  
type of any Remote Storage connection(s).  
Request Data  
-
-
C0  
19  
02  
00  
NetFnlLUN: OEM  
CMD : Command Group Firmware  
1
2
3
00 = Connection 0  
01 = Connection 2  
Response Data  
-
C4  
-
19  
1
2
3
4
5
Completion Code  
02  
00  
00  
00 = Invalid / unknown  
01 = idle  
02 = Connection Attempt pending  
03 = Connected  
04 = Connection Attempts retries exhausted / failed  
05 = Connection lost  
06 = Disconnect pending  
6
00 = Invalid / unknown  
01 = Storage Server / IPMI  
02 = Applet  
03 = None / Not connected  
iRMC S2/S3  
399  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
C0 1A - Set Video Display On/Off  
This command allows you to switch the local console on or off.  
Request Data  
-
-
C0  
1A  
NetFnlLUN: OEM  
Cmd : Command Group Fan Test  
1
00 = Set Video Display On  
01 = Set Video display Off  
Response Data  
-
-
C4  
1A  
1
Completion Code  
12.1.2.6 BIOS-specific commands  
F1 09 - Get BIOS POST State  
This command provides information whether BIOS is in POST.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F1  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BIOS  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
09  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
BC  
F1  
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
[7:1] - reserved  
[0] - BIOS POST State : 0 = BIOS is not in POST  
1 = BIOS is in POST  
400  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F1 15 - Get CPU Info  
This command returns CPU-internal information. The iRMC S2/S3 gets this  
information from the BIOS during the POST phase.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F1  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BIOS  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
15 Command Specifier  
5
Socket Number (0-based) of the CPU  
Response Data  
-
BC  
F1  
-
1
Completion Code:  
01 = Unpopulated CPU Socket  
2:4  
5:6  
7
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
CPU ID, LS Byte first  
Platform ID  
8
Brand ID  
9:10  
11:12  
Maximal Core Speed of the CPU [MHz], LS Byte first  
Intel Qickpath Interconnect in Mega Transactions per  
second, LS Byte first  
13  
14  
T-Control Offset  
T-Diode Offset  
15  
CPU data Spare  
16:17  
18:19  
20:21  
Record ID CPU Info SDR, LS Byte first  
Record ID Fan Control SDR, LS Byte first  
CPU ID High Word, LS Byte first (0 if none)  
iRMC S2/S3  
401  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
12.1.2.7 iRMC S2/S3-specific commands  
F5 10 - Get System Status  
This command returns a variety of internal information on the system such as  
the power state, error status, etc.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Memory  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
10 Command Specifier  
5:8  
-
Timestamp  
Response Data  
BC  
-
F5  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
System Status (For details see below.)  
Signaling (For details see below.)  
Notifications (For details see below.)  
POST Code  
6
7
8
I
The Timestamp is only relevant for evaluating the Notifications Byte.  
System Status  
Bit 7 - System ON  
Bit 6 -  
Bit 5 -  
Bit 4 - SEL entries available  
Bit 3 -  
Bit 2 - Watchdog active  
Bit 1 - Agent connected  
Bit 0 - Post State  
402  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
Signaling  
Bit 7 - Localize LED  
Bit 6 -  
Bit 5 -  
Bit 4 -  
Bit 3 - CSS LED  
Bit 2 - CSS LED  
Bit 1 - Global Error LED  
Bit 0 - Global Error LED  
Notifications  
Bit 7 - SEL Modified (New SEL Entry)  
Bit 6 - SEL Modified (SEL Cleared)  
Bit 5 - SDR Modified  
Bit 4 - Nonvolatile IPMI Variable Modified  
Bit 3 - ConfigSpace Modified  
Bit 2 -  
Bit 1 -  
Bit 0 - New Output on LocalView display  
iRMC S2/S3  
403  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 12 - Get EEPROM Version Info  
This command returns information on the current versions (bootloader,  
firmware and SDR) stored in the EEPROM(s).  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group Memory  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
12 Command Specifier  
5
EEPROM# 00=EEPROM 1; 01=EEPROM 2  
Response Data  
-
BC  
-
F5  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
Status  
00=Checksum Error Runtime FW, 01=OK  
6
Major FW Revision  
Minor FW Revision  
Aux. FW Revision  
Major FW Revision  
Major SDRR Revision  
Minor SDRR Revision  
SDRR Revision Char.  
SDRR-ID  
Binary coded  
BCD coded  
7
8:10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19:20  
Binary coded (major/minor/res.)  
ASCII coded letter  
BCD coded  
BCD coded  
ASCII coded letter  
LSB binary coded  
MSB binary coded  
Binary coded  
SDRR-ID  
Major Booter Revision  
Major Booter Revision  
Aux. Booter Revision  
BCD coded  
Binary coded (major/minor)  
404  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 42 - Get HDD lightpath status (Component Status Signal Read)  
This command returns information on the state of a Hard Disk Drive (HDD) slot.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFn|LUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group iRMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
42 Command Specifier  
5
Entity ID (Table 37-12 of IPMI 1.5 Spec.) of Component  
whose Status Signal is to be read.  
6
7
Entity Instance (0-based) of Component whose Status  
Signal is to be read.  
Sensor Type (Table 36-3 of IPMISpec.) of the Sensor which  
reports the Status of the Component to which the Status  
Signal is associated.  
(8)  
Option (optional)  
Bit 7:2 - Reserved  
Bit 1  
Bit 0  
:Completion Code 0x02 suppressed  
- 1 : Return ID String of Component Status Sensor  
Response Data  
-
-
BC  
F5  
1
Completion Code:  
01= Status Signal not available  
02 = Component not present  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
Signal Status:  
00 = ok  
01 = Identify  
02 = Prefailure Warning  
03 = Failure  
6
CSS and Physical LED available:  
Bit 6:0 - 0= No physical LED available  
Bit 6:0 > 00 = Physical LED available, Single or Multiple  
Color, Code  
Bit 7 = 0: No CSS Component  
Bit 7 = 1: CSS Component  
(7)  
Length of ID String of Component Status Sensor  
(only present if Bit 0 in Request Byte 8 is set)  
(8 .. m) Length of ID String of Component Status Sensor in ASCII  
chasracters  
(only present if Bit 0 in Request Byte 8 is set)  
iRMC S2/S3  
405  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 43 - Get SEL entry long text  
This command translates a given SEL entry into long text.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFn|LUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group iRMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
43  
Command Specifier  
5:6  
Record ID  
of SEL record, LS Byte first  
0x0000: get first record  
0xFFFF: get last record  
7
8
Offset  
in response SEL text  
MaxResponseDataSize size of Converted SEL data  
(16:n) in response  
Response Data  
-
-
BC  
F5  
1
Completion Code:  
2:4  
5:6  
7:8  
9
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
Next Record ID  
Actual Record ID  
Record type  
10:13  
14  
Timestamp  
Severity:  
Bit 7:  
0 = No CSS component  
1 = CSS component  
Bit 6-4: 000 = INFORMATIONAL  
001 = MINOR  
010 = MAJOR  
011 = CRITICAL  
1xx = Unknown’  
Bit 3-0:  
reserved, read as 0000  
15  
Data length of the whole text  
16:n  
Converted SEL data requested part  
(n = 16 + MaxResponseDataSize - 1)  
n + 1  
String Terminator  
trailing '\0' character  
406  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 45 - Get SEL Entry Text  
This command translates a given System Event Log SEL entry into ASCII text.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group iRMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
45 Command Specifier  
5:6  
-
Record ID of SDR, LS Byte first  
Response Data  
BC  
-
F5  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5:6  
7:8  
9
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS Byte first  
Next Record ID  
Actual Record ID  
Record type  
10:13  
14  
Timestamp  
Severity:  
Bit 7:  
0 = No CSS component  
1 = CSS component  
000 = INFORMATIONAL  
001 = MINOR  
Bit 6-4:  
010 = MAJOR  
011 = CRITICAL  
1xx = Unknown’  
Bit 3-0:  
reserved, read as 0000  
15  
Data length  
16:35  
Converted SEL data  
iRMC S2/S3  
407  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 B0 - Set Identify LED  
This command allows you to switch the Identify LED (blue) of the server on and  
off. In addition, you can set and read the GPIOs that are directly connected to  
the Identify LED.  
I
You can also switch the Identify LED on and off using the Identify switch  
on the server.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
B0 Command Specifier  
5
Identify LED:  
0: Identify LED off  
1: Identify LED on  
Response Data  
-
-
BC  
F5  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
F5 B1 - Get Identify LED  
This command returns information on the status of the Identify LED (blue) of the  
server.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
B1  
BC  
F5  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
State of Identify LED (only bit 0 is relevant)  
408  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 B3 - Get Error LED  
This command returns information on the status of the server’s Global Error  
LED (red) and CSS LED (yellow). The Global Error LED indicates the most  
serious error status of the components. The CSS LED indicates, whether the  
customer himself can rpair the fault.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
B3  
BC  
F5  
Command Specifier  
Response Data  
-
-
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
5
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
State of Error LED:  
0 : CSS off / GEL off  
1 : CSS off / GEL on  
2 : CSS off / GEL blink  
3 : CSS on / GEL off  
4 : CSS on / GEL on  
5 : CSS on / GEL blink  
6 : CSS blink / GEL off  
7 : CSS blink / GEL on  
8 : CSS blink / GEL blink  
iRMC S2/S3  
409  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 DF - Reset Nonvolatile Cfg Variables to Default  
This command forces all non-volatile IPMI settings to be set to default values.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
DF Command Specifier  
5:8  
-
43 4C 52 AA = ’CLR’0xaa: Security Code  
Response Data  
BC  
-
F5  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
F5 E0 - Reset ConfigSpace variables to default  
This command forces all Configuration Space variables to be set to default  
values.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
E0 Command Specifier  
5:8  
-
43 4C 52 AA = ’CLR’0xaa: Security Code  
Response Data  
BC  
-
F5  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
410  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IPMI OEM Commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
F5 F8 - Delete User ID  
The system supports up to 16 users. This command allows individual  
iRMC S2/S3 users to be deleted.  
V
CAUTION!  
The system can no longer be managed if all iRMC S2/S3 users are  
deleted.  
Request Data  
-
-
B8  
F5  
NetFnlLUN: OEM/Group  
Cmd : Command Group BMC  
1:3  
4
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
F8 Command Specifier  
5:8  
-
User ID (1-16)  
Response Data  
BC  
-
F5  
1
Completion Code  
2:4  
80 28 00 IANA-Enterprise-Number FTS, LS byte first  
iRMC S2/S3  
411  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2 Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and  
scripted configuration  
This section provides information on the following topics:  
How to use an SCCI (ServerView Common Command Interface) compliant  
interface for configuring the iRMC S2/S3.  
Scripted configuration of the iRMC S2/S3  
12.2.1 iRMC S2/S3 configuration data  
I
Please note that the interface described below is mainly for remote  
configuration and is not an SCCI implementation. It only uses the SCCI  
command and configuration definitions and the SCCI file format.  
12.2.1.1 Overview  
The iRMC S2/S3 stores internal configuration data in two separate sections of  
its NVRAM (Non-volatile RAM):  
FTS-specific ConfigSpace data, which is addressed by the firmware via a  
fixed internal description table.  
Original, manufacturer-specific NVCFG data, which is accessed by offset  
definitions.  
Some configuration data from the original NVCFG data is internally mapped by  
the firmware to be accessible via ConfigSpace access methods. For instance,  
DNS servers and DNS configuration of the iRMC S2/S3 can be accessed both  
via IPMI OEM LAN configuration parameters and via ConfigSpace. Both  
methods access the same low level data structures in the original NVCFG area.  
Non-iRMC S2/S3-specific ServerView software components (e.g. the  
ServerView Agents or the Server Configuration Manager) in some cases also  
map standard IPMI related commands and configuration items, such as  
standard IPMI user configuration or IPv4 network configuration. This  
implements an abstraction level between the IPMI BMC layer and higher  
software levels.  
412  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
The SCCI is a generic application programming interface (API) defined by  
Fujitsu for different Server Management Controller hardware as well as Server  
Management software (e.g. ServerView Agents). It can be easily extended to  
cover new commands or new configuration items. For an architectural overview  
of the SCCI, see the online help of the ServerView agents.  
Starting with iRMC S2 firmware 5.20A (IPv6 version), the iRMC S2/S3 supports  
remote configuration and limited scripting via the /config URL in the  
iRMC S2/S3.  
Benefits of remote iRMC S2/S3 configuration via web-based access  
Remote configuration of the iRMC S2/S3 via web-based access provides the  
following benefits:  
Uses HTTP POST operation for uploading files onto the iRMC S2/S3. No  
special tool is required. Any generic tool or scripting environments  
supporting authenticated HTTP POST operations can be used. Sample  
scripts can be found on the ServerView Suite DVD 1.  
Uses built-in authentication and authorization methods of the iRMC S2/S3  
Web server.  
Supports HTTP 1.1 Basic and Digest authentication based on RFC 2617  
with local iRMC S2/S3 user accounts.  
Features optional built-in strong encryption with standard HTTPS-based  
access.  
Can be used with global user accounts (managed by an LDAP directory  
service) and HTTP 1.1 Basic authentication.  
I
If HTTP 1.1 Basic authentication is used, it is recommended that, for  
encryption and confidentiality reasons, you use the HTTPS protocol  
to protect the username/password combination.  
Uses a configuration file format that is based on XML. You have the option  
to edit the file manually, or to export it from a reference installation or from  
the Server Configuration Manager.  
The configuration file can be re-used with other SCCI based installation  
methods (e.g. Server Configuration Manager).  
Can be easily extended to new configuration items and new supported SCCI  
commands.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
413  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2.1.2 SCCI file format  
I
The format of the XML configuration file (.pre) used is taken from the  
setup configuration help file that is installed together with the ServerView  
agents on Windows platforms. A copy of this description with  
iRMC S2/S3-specific notes is shown below.  
The configuration file is a based on XML syntax:  
Each configuration setting consists of a simple XML fragment starting with  
a "<CMD>" tag.  
The complete sequence of configuration settings is enclosed in a pair of tags  
"<CMDSEQ>and </CMDSEQ>".  
The following is an example of a typical command sequence comprising two  
configuration settings:  
<CMDSEQ>  
<CMD Context="SCCI" OC="ConfigSpace" OE="3800" OI="0"  
Type="SET">  
<DATA Type="xsd::hexBinary" Len="1">04</DATA>  
<CMD Context="SCCI" OC="ConfigSpace" OE="3801" OI="0"  
Type="SET">  
<DATA Type="xsd::hexBinary" Len="1">00</DATA> </CMD>  
</CMDSEQ>  
The Context parameter is used internally to select the provider of the operation.  
Currently, SCCIis the only supported provider.  
414  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
Parameters of SCCI provider-specific commands  
The following SCCI-provider-specific commands are available:  
Operation Code (OC)  
Hex value or string specifying the command / operation code.  
I
The iRMC S2/S3 only supports a limited set of SCCI commands.  
For a list of supported commands see table "SCCI commands  
Operation Code Extension (OE)  
Hex value for extended operation code. Default: OE=0  
For ConfigSpace Read-/Write operations, this value defines the  
ConfigSpace ID.  
Object Index (OI)  
Hex value selecting an instance of an object. Default:OI=0"  
Operation Code Type (Type)  
For configuration settings, the values GET(read operation) and SET(write  
operation) are supported. Default: Type=GET  
I
SEToperations require data. For specifying the appropriate data  
type, use the Data (DATA) parameter described below.  
Cabinet Identifier (CA)  
Allows you to select an extension cabinet and use its cabinet ID number.  
I
Do not use this parameter to request for the system cabinet!  
Data (DATA)  
If a SETparameter (write operation) is specified: Data type (Type  
parameter), and, in some cases, data length (LENparameter) are  
required.  
Currently, the following data types are supported:  
xsd::integer  
Integer value  
Example  
<DATA Type="xsd::integer">1234</DATA>  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
415  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
xsd::hexBinary  
Stream of bytes. Each byte is coded in two ASCII characters. Use the  
Lenparameter as shown in the example below to specify the length  
of the stream (i.e. the number of bytes).  
The data type xsd::hexBinarycan be used without any restriction.  
Example  
A stream of four bytes 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x04will be coded as  
the following ASCII stream:  
<DATA Type="xsd::hexBinary" Len="4">0001020304</DATA>  
xsd::string  
Normally used for the transfer of strings. Additionally, the stringtype  
can be used for IPv4 addresses and MD5-based user passwords. In  
this case, the string data is internally converted to the accepted target  
format.  
Transferring encrypted data  
A Fujitsu-proprietary data encryption is supported for some sensitive  
data such as user or service (LDAP/SMTP) access passwords, or the  
AVR license key of the iRMC S2/S3. You can use the iRMC_PWD.exe  
program for encrypting password data (see section "Generating  
Encrypted="1"must be set in the <DATA>tag to indicate that the  
data to be written is encrypted.  
Examples  
Transferring the string "Hello World":  
<DATA Type="xsd::string">Hello World</DATA>  
Transferring a password as clear (readable) text:  
<DATA Type="xsd::string">My Readable Password</DATA>  
Transferring an encrypted password:  
<DATA Type="xsd::string"  
Encrypted="1">TpVlTJwCyHEIsC8tk24ci83JuR9l</DATA>  
416  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
Transferring the IPv4 address "192.23.2.4"  
V <DATA Type="xsd::string">192.23.2.4</DATA>  
CAUTION!  
The xsd::stringdata type is restricted to readable strings, IP  
addresses and MD5-based user passwords.  
I For all other data, the xsd::hexbinarydata type must be used!  
Do not directly specify the characters ä, ö, ü, etc. in strings  
unless they are actually needed by the using application!  
Both SCCI and the ConfigSpace interface do not store any  
character encoding information. Thus, any non-US-ASCII-  
characters will be interpreted internally by the using application  
and therefore should be avoided.  
If you do actually need to specify special characters, make sure  
that you edit and save your file in UTF-8 format including the  
correct BOM.  
Command Status (Status)  
After the configuration settings are transferred, the Statuscontains the  
result of the operation. If the operation has completed successfully, the  
I value 0is returned.  
For a specification of all public configuration settings (ConfigSpace) see  
the SCCI_CS.pdf file, which you will find in the Help folder of the  
ServerView Agents installation package. Additionally, the SCCI_CS.pdf  
file is distributed with the PRIMERGY Scripting Toolkit.I  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
417  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2.1.3 Restrictions  
All commands specified in the .pre file are normally executed sequentially. The  
following are exemptions from this rule:  
To prevent broken network connectivity, commands for IPv4 and VLAN  
network configuration are executed at the end of a command sequence.  
Currently, IPv6 configuration is limited to the configuration of the non-volatile  
IPv6 configuration parameters.  
As a workaround, you can proceed as follows:  
1. Arrange your script as follows:  
a) At the beginning of the script: Disable IPv6.  
b) Configure IPv6 parameters.  
c) At the end of the script: Enable IPv6  
2. Submit the script from an IPv4 address.  
The SSL certificate and the related matching private key are executed at the  
end of a command sequence. Both components must be present in the  
same .pre file and are checked for matching each other.  
If a power management operation for the managed server or a reboot of the  
iRMC S2/S3 is required or desired:  
It is recommended (but not required) to run these commands in separate  
command files. You can achieve this e.g. by splitting the configuration and  
power management operations into separate tasks.  
Optional time delays between the execution of consecutive commands must  
implemented outside the script.  
For example, you can achieve this as follows:  
1. Devide the script appropriately into separate scripts.  
2. Use the functional range of the client to insert time delays between  
sending the individual files.  
418  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2.1.4 Exporting / importing configuration data from / on the  
iRMC S2/S3  
The Save iRMC S2/S3 Firmware Settings page of the iRMC S2/S3 web interface  
allows you to save (export) the current iRMC S2/S3 configuration data in a  
configuration file (.pre). As well, you can import iRMC S2/S3 configuration data  
from an existing configuration file (.pre), i.e. load configuration data onto the  
To import an iRMC S2/S3 configuration, you can alternatively send the  
corresponding SCCI command file to the /config URI of the iRMC S2/S3 via the  
HTTP POST operation.  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
419  
 
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2.2 Scripted configuration of the iRMC S2/S3  
This section describes provides information on the following topics:  
SCCI commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3.  
Using various script languages for scripted configuration of the iRMC S2/S3.  
Generating encrypted passwords with the iRMC_PWD.exe program.  
12.2.2.1 List of SCCI commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
The SCCI commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3 are shown in table 19:  
SCCI OpCode SCCI Command String  
Description  
0xE002  
0x0111  
0x0112  
0x0113  
0x0204  
0x020C  
ConfigSpace  
ConfigSpace Write  
PowerOnCabinet  
PowerOffCabinet  
PowerOffOnCabinet  
ResetServer  
Power On the Server  
Power Off the Server  
Power Cycle the Server  
Hard Reset the Server  
Pulse the NMI (Non Maskable Interrupt)  
RaiseNMI  
RequestShutdownAndOff  
Graceful Shutdown, requires running  
Agent  
0x0205  
0x0206  
0x0209  
0x0203  
RequestShutdownAndReset  
ShutdownRequestCancelled  
ResetFirmware  
Graceful Reboot, requires running Agent  
Cancel a Shutdown Request  
Perform a BMC Reset  
ConnectRemoteStorageServer  
Connect or Disconnect a standalone  
Remote Storage Server  
0x0250  
Table 19: SCCI commands supported by the iRMC S2/S3  
420  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2.2.2 Scripting with cURL  
The open source command-line tool cURL allows you to transfer data specified  
with URL syntax. You can download the latest version of the source code as well  
as precompiled versions for different operating systems from http://curl.haxx.se/.  
The following are some examples of how to use curl to send a configuration file  
to the iRMC S2/S3.  
I
For details on the curl command line options please refer to the curl  
documentation.  
HTTP Access with Basic Authentication (default) and the default  
iRMC S2/S3 admin account:  
curl --basic -u admin:admin --data @Config.pre  
http://<iRMC S2/S3 IP address>/config  
HTTP Access with Digest Authentication and the default iRMC admin  
account  
curl --digest -u admin:admin --data @Config.pre  
http://<iRMC S2/S3 IP address>/config  
HTTPS Access with no certificate check (-k) and Digest authentication and  
the default iRMC admin account:  
curl --digest -k -u admin:admin --data @Config.pre  
https://<iRMC S2/S3 IP address>/config  
HTTPS Access with an LDAP user account.  
Please note, that for LDAP users you have to specify Basic authentication  
curl --basic -k -u LDAPuser:LDAPpassword --data @Config.pre  
https://<iRMC S2/S3 IP address>/config  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
421  
 
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2.2.3 Scripting with Visual Basic (VB) Script  
The following VB script sends a configuration file to the iRMC S2/S3:  
IP_ADDRESS = "<iRMC S2/S3 IP address>"  
USER_NAME = "admin"  
PASSWORD = "admin"  
FILE_NAME = ".\\ConfigFile.pre"  
Const ForReading = 1  
Set objFSO = CreateObject("Scripting.FileSystemObject")  
Set objFile = objFSO.OpenTextFile(FILE_NAME, ForReading)  
' --------------------------------------------------------------  
On Error Resume Next  
Set xmlHttp = CreateObject("Microsoft.XMLHTTP")  
xmlHttp.Open "POST", "http://" & IP_ADDRESS & "/config", False,  
USER_NAME, PASSWORD  
xmlhttp.setRequestHeader "Content-Type", "application/x-www-  
form-urlencoded"  
xmlHttp.Send objFile.ReadAll  
Wscript.Echo xmlhttp.responsexml.xml  
422  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
12.2.2.4 Scripting with Python  
#!/usr/bin/python3  
import sys  
import httplib2  
from urllib.parse import urlencode  
# ==============================================================  
# iRMC  
USER = 'admin'  
PWD = 'admin'  
IP_ADDR = '192.168.1.100'  
# ==============================================================  
h = httplib2.Http()  
# Basic/Digest authentication  
h.add_credentials(USER, PWD)  
def doit(data,ausgabe=sys.stdout):  
try:  
resp, content = h.request("http://%s/config" % IP_ADDR,  
"POST", data)  
if resp['status'] == '200'  
data = content.decode('utf-8')  
print(data,file=ausgabe)  
else:  
print('STATUS:',resp['status'],file=ausgabe)  
print(str(resp),file=ausgabe)  
except Exception as err:  
print('ERROR:',str(err),file=ausgabe)  
print()  
# Example 1 - send a configuration file to the iRMC S2/S3  
try:  
data = open('ConfigFile.pre').read()  
doit(data)  
except Exception as err:  
print('ERROR:',str(err),file=ausgabe)  
# Example 2 - Set Config Space Values  
# 0x200 (ConfCabinetLocation) and  
# 0x204 (ConfSystemContact) direct from the script  
#
LocationContact = '''<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"  
standalone="yes" ?>  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
423  
 
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
<CMDSEQ>  
<!-- ConfCabinetLocation -->  
<CMD Context="SCCI" OC="ConfigSpace" OE="200" OI="0" >  
<DATA Type="xsd::string">%s</DATA>  
</CMD>  
<!-- ConfSystemContact -->  
<CMD Context="SCCI" OC="ConfigSpace" OE="204" OI="0" >  
<DATA Type="xsd::string">%s</DATA>  
</CMD>  
</CMDSEQ>  
'''  
doit(LocationContact % ("Ostsee","Kiel"))  
12.2.2.5 Generating encrypted passwords with iRMC_PWD.exe  
The Fujitsu Technology Solutions iRMC password encryption and verification  
Utility iRMC_PWD.exe is a Win32 program allowing you to generate encrypted  
passwords for use with SCCI scripting. iRMC_PWD.exe can be used both to  
encrypt a single password and to generate a SCCI batch file for scripted  
configuration.  
iRMC_PWD standard command line options  
[-h] [-?]  
This help.  
[-v]  
Verify an encrypted password string.  
[-o] <oid>  
The Object ID for the data to be encrypted.  
[-u] <username>  
Username for the given Object ID (optional).  
[-p] <password>  
Password for the given Object ID / / encrypted password string to be  
verified.  
[-x] <opCodeExt>  
Opcode extension for the ConfigSpace data to encrypt.  
424  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
[-p] <password>  
Password for the given Object ID.  
Default:1452 (ConfBMCAcctUserPassword)  
Supported values:  
1273 - ConfAlarmEmailSMTPAuthPassword  
[-p] <password>  
Password for the given Object ID.  
Default: 1452 (ConfBMCAcctUserPassword)  
Supported Values:  
1452 - ConfBMCAcctUserPassword  
1273 - ConfAlarmEmailSMTPAuthPassword  
197A - ConfLdapiRMCgroupsUserPasswd  
1980 - ConfBMCLicenseKey  
iRMC_PWD command line output options  
[-b]  
Creates the output file as a WinSCU BATCH file.  
[-f] <Output File>  
Specify the output file name.  
Default: iRMC_pwd.txt  
Default in Batch mode: iRMC_pwd.pre  
Example  
You want to generate a .pre file that sets/changes the username to admin  
and the password to SecretPasswordfor the (existing) user with the oid 2.  
To achieve this, enter the following command:  
iRMC_PWD -o 2 -u admin -p SecretPassword -b  
iRMC_PWD will generate a .pre file with the contents shown in figure 226 on  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
425  
Configuring the iRMC S2/S3 via SCCI and scripted configuration  
Figure 226: Contents of the generated .pre file  
426  
iRMC S2/S3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 

Continental Electric Can Opener CE22261 User Manual
Continental Electric Toaster CE23551 User Manual
Craftsman Chainsaw 35835181 User Manual
Craftsman Lawn Mower 107289920 User Manual
Craftsman Yard Vacuum 2477701 User Manual
Crate Amplifiers Stereo Amplifier GT 200 User Manual
Cypress Clock CY25818 User Manual
Extron electronic Stereo Amplifier MPA 401 User Manual
Fisher Price Model Vehicle W9830 User Manual
GE Double Oven JBP24 User Manual